Mdmotors - Polaris Sportsman 700 800 800 x2 Efi 2007 Servis Remont
Mdmotors - Polaris Sportsman 700 800 800 x2 Efi 2007 Servis Remont
Mdmotors - Polaris Sportsman 700 800 800 x2 Efi 2007 Servis Remont
SERVICE MANUAL
FOREWORD
This service manual is designed primarily for use by certified Polaris Master Service Dealer technicians in a properly
equipped shop and should be kept available for reference. All references to left and right side of the vehicle are from
the operator's perspective when seated in a normal riding position.
Some procedures outlined in this manual require a sound knowledge of mechanical theory, tool use, and shop
procedures in order to perform the work safely and correctly. Technicians should read the text and be familiar with service
procedures before starting the work. Certain procedures require the use of special tools. Use only the proper tools as
specified.
Comments or suggestions about this manual may be directed to: Service Publications Dept. @ Polaris Sales Inc. 2100
Hwy 55 Medina Minnesota 55340.
2007 Sportsman 700/800/ 800 X2 EFI Service Manual PN 9920378
Copyright 2006 Polaris Sales Inc. All information contained within this publication is based on the latest product information at the time of publication. Due to constant
improvements in the design and quality of production components, some minor discrepancies may result between the actual vehicle and the information presented in this
publication. Depictions and/or procedures in this publication are intended for reference use only. No liability can be accepted for omissions or inaccuracies. Any reprinting
or reuse of the depictions and/or procedures contained within, whether whole or in part, is expressly prohibited. Printed in U.S.A.
UNDERSTANDING MANUAL SAFETY LABELS AND DIRECTIONS
Throughout this manual, important information is brought to your attention by the following symbols:
WARNING
SAFETY ALERT WARNING indicates a potential hazard that may result in severe injury or death to the operator, bystander or
person(s) inspecting or servicing the vehicle.
CAUTION
SAFETY ALERT CAUTION indicates a potential hazard that may result in minor personal injury or damage to the vehicle.
CAUTION
CAUTION indicates special precautions that must be taken to avoid vehicle damage or property damage.
NOTE:
TRADEMARKS
POLARIS ACKNOWLEDGES THE FOLLOWING PRODUCTS MENTIONED IN THIS MANUAL:
Loctite, Registered Trademark of the Loctite Corporation
Nyogel, Trademark of Wm. F. Nye Co.
Fluke, Registered Trademark of John Fluke Mfg. Co.
Mity-Vac, Registered Trademark of Neward Enterprises, Inc.
Torx, Registered Trademark of Textron
Hilliard, Trademark of the Hilliard Corporation
Warn, Trademark of Warn Industries
Some Polaris factory publications can be downloaded from www.polarisindustires.com, purchased from www.purepolaris.com or
by contacting the nearest Polaris dealer.
GENERAL 1
MAINTENENCE 2
ENGINE 3
FUEL SYSTEM 4
BODY / SUSPENSION 5
CLUTCH 6
TRANSMISSION 7
FINAL DRIVE 8
BRAKES 9
ELECTRICAL 10
INTERNATIONAL 11
NOTES
GENERAL INFORMATION
CHAPTER 1
GENERAL INFORMATION
1
MODEL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
MODEL NUMBER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
ENGINE DESIGNATION NUMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
VIN IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
TRANSMISSION I.D. LOCATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
ENGINE AND MACHINE SERIAL NUMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
SPORTSMAN DELUXE AND STANDARD MODEL COMPONENT COMPARISON . . 1.3
2007 SPORTSMAN 700 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4
MODEL NUMBER: A07MH68AX, A07MH68AY, A07MH68AZ, . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4
2007 SPORTSMAN 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.6
MODEL NUMBER: A07MH76A, A07MN76A, A07MH76F. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.6
2007 SPORTSMAN X2 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8
MODEL NUMBER: A07TH76A, A07TN76A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8
MISC. NUMBERS/CHARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10
PUBLICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10
PAINT CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10
REPLACEMENT KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10
STANDARD TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.11
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.11
SAE TAP DRILL SIZES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.12
METRIC TAP DRILL SIZES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.12
DECIMAL EQUIVALENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.12
CONVERSION TABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.13
GLOSSARY OF TERMS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.14
1.1
GENERAL INFORMATION
MODEL INFORMATION Engine and Machine Serial Numbers
Be sure to refer to the engine model number and serial number
Model Number whenever corresponding about an engine.
The machine model number must be used with any
correspondence regarding warranty or service.
This information can be found on the sticker applied to the top
side of the crankcase (A). An additional number is stamped on
A 07 MH 76 AU the side of the crankcase beneath the cylinder coolant elbow.
VIN Identification
7
xx
xxx
xxx
Sportsman
1.2
GENERAL INFORMATION
PUBLICATIONS
PAINT CODES
REPLACEMENT KEYS
Replacement keys can be made from the original key. To identify which series the key is, take the first two digits on the original
key and refer to the chart to the right for the proper part number. Should both keys become lost, ignition switch replacement is
required.
1.3
GENERAL INFORMATION
Sportsman Deluxe and Standard Model Component Comparison
For Model Year 2007, a Sportsman Deluxe and Standard model were offered. Use the following table as a guide:
10
9
4
1.4
GENERAL INFORMATION
Sportsman X2 Deluxe and Standard Model Component Comparison
For Model Year 2007, an X2 Deluxe and Standard model were offered. Use the following table as a guide: 1
X2 DELUXE MODEL Item Location X2 STANDARD MODEL
Winch 1 No Winch
Rear Work Lights 2 No Work Lights
Front Drive w/ Active Descent Control (ADC) 3 No Active Descent Control (ADC)
Cast Aluminum Wheels 4 Steel Wheels
1.5
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.6
GENERAL INFORMATION
Table 1-5: 2007 700 EFI Specifications Table 1-6: 2007 700 EFI Specifications
ENGINE Drivetrain 1
Platform Polaris Twin Cylinder Transmission Type Drumshift - H/L/N/Rev/Park
Engine Model Number EH068OLE025 Transmission Capacity 15 oz. / 445 ml
Oil Requirements / Capacity Polaris 0W-40 2 qt. / 1.9 ltr Front Travel 8.2 in. / 21 cm
Exhaust System Single Pipe USFS Approved Rear Suspension / Shock Progressive Rate Independent -
Coil - over shock
Fuel System
Rear Travel 9.5 in. / 24.13 cm
Fuel System Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
Ground Clearance 11.25 in. / 28.6 cm
Fuel Pump (in tank assembly) 25L per hr. at 39 psi
Shock Preload Adjustment Front -Non Adjustable.
Fuel Filter(s) 30 micron in Tank - (unserviceable) Front / Rear Rear - Ratchet Style- Std.
10 micron in-line (replaceable)
Turning Radius 76 in. / 193 cm unlocked
Fuel Injector(s) Bosch
Toe Out 0-1/16 in / .0 - .159 mm
EFI Controller Bosch MSE 1.1B
Fuel Capacity / Requirement 4.13 gal US / 15.6 liters
Wheels / Brakes
87 Octane (minimum) or 89 Oxygenated Wheel Size / Pattern - Front Steel 24 x 8-12 / 4-156
Electrical Wheel Size / Pattern - Rear Steel 24 x 11-12 / 4-156
Alternator Output 500 w @ 6000 RPM Front Tire Size 24 x 8-12
Lights : Pod 50 watts Rear Tire Size 24 x 11-12
Grill Two x 27 watts Recommended Air Pressure Front & Rear - 5 psi
Brake 8.26 watts Brake - Front Dual Hydraulic Disc
Tail 26.9 watts Brake - Rear Dual Hydraulic Disc
Ignition System DC/CDI Ignition
Ignition Timing 13 BTDC @ 1200 RPM Table 1-7: 2007 700 EFI Clutching
Spark plug / Gap RC7YC / .035 in. / 0.9 mm Altitude
Shift Drive Clutch Driven Clutch Type
Battery / Amp Hr Lead Acid / 30 Amp Hr. Meters Weight Spring (Non-Adjustable)
(Feet)
Circuit Breakers Fan 20 amp / Harness 20 amp / 0-1800 A07MH68 20-58 Grn/Blu
STD - 1322514
ECU 15 amp / Inst. Cluster / (0-6000) (STANDARD) 5631216 7041157
Voltage Regulator 6 amp 1800-3700 A07MH68 20-56 Grn/Blu
STD - 1322514
(6000-12000) (STANDARD) 5631215 7041157
Starting Electric
Instrument Cluster Analog Speedo w/ LCD
1.7
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.8
GENERAL INFORMATION
Table 1-9: 2007 800 EFI Specifications Table 1-10: 2007 800 EFI Specifications
ENGINE Drivetrain 1
Platform Polaris Twin Cylinder Transmission Type Drumshift - H/L/N/Rev/Park
Engine Model Number EH076OLE013 Transmission Capacity 15 oz. / 450ml
Exhaust System Dual Pipe / Silencer (Deluxe) Front Travel 8.2 in. / 21 cm
Single Pipe / Silencer (Standard) Rear Suspension / Shock Progressive Rate Independent -
Fuel System Coil - over shock
Fuel System Electronic Fuel Injection Rear Travel 9.5 in. / 24.13 cm
Fuel Pump 25L per hour at 39 PSI Ground Clearance 11.25 in. / 28.6 cm
Fuel Filter(s) 30 micron in Tank - (unserviceable) Shock Preload Adjustment Front -Non Adjustable.
10 micron in Line (replaceable) Front / Rear Rear - Ratchet Style- Std.
1.9
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.10
GENERAL INFORMATION
Table 1-13: 2007 800 X2 EFI Specifications Table 1-14: 2007 800 X2 EFI Specifications
ENGINE Drivetrain 1
Platform Polaris Twin Cylinder Transmission Type Drumshift - H/L/N/Rev/Park
Engine Model Number EH076OLE013 Transmission Capacity 32 oz. / 946.3ml
Fuel System Electronic Fuel Injection Ground Clearance 11.25 in. / 28.6 cm
Fuel Pump 25L per hour at 39 PSI Shock Preload Adjustment Front -Non Adjustable.
Front / Rear Rear - Ratchet Style- Std.
Fuel Filter(s) 30 micron in Tank - (unserviceable)
10 micron in Tank - (unserviceable) Turning Radius 82 in. / 208.2 cm
10 micron in Line (replaceable) Toe Out 0 - 1/16 in / .0 - .159 mm
Fuel Injector(s) Bosch Wheels / Brakes
EFI Controller Bosch MSE 1.1B Wheel Size / Pattern - Front 25 x 8 - 12 / 4-156
Fuel Capacity / Requirement 6.0 gal US / 22.7 liters Wheel Size / Pattern - Rear 25 x 11 - 12 / 4-156
87 Octane (minimum) or 89 Oxygenated
Front Tire Size 25 x 8 - 12
Electrical
Rear Tire Size 25 x 11 - 12
Alternator Output 500 w @ 6000 RPM
Recommended Air Pressure Front - 5 psi & Rear - 5 psi
Lights : Pod 50 watts
Brake - Front Dual Hydraulic Disc
Grill Two x 37 watts
Brake - Rear Dual Hydraulic Disc
Tail 2 x 26.9 watts
Brake 2 x 8.26 watts
Table 1-15: 2007 800 X2 EFI Clutching
Worklights
2 x 13 watts Altitude
(Deluxe Only) Shift Drive Clutch Driven Clutch Type
Meters Weight Spring (Non-Adjustable)
Indicator Panel 1 watt (Feet)
Ignition System DC/CDI Ignition A07TH76A Grn/Blu
0-1800 (STANDARD) 20-62
Ignition Timing Variable - ECU controlled 7041157 EBS - 1322550
(0-6000) A07TN76A w/EBS
(DELUXE) w/EBS
Spark plug / Gap RC7YC/ .035 in. / 0.9 mm
A07TH76A Grn/Blu
Battery / Amp Hr Lead Acid / 30 Amp Hr 1800-3700 (STANDARD) 20-58
7041157 EBS - 1322550
Fuses Fan 20 amp / Harness 20 amp / (6000-12000) A07TN76A w/EBS
(DELUXE) w/EBS
ECU 15 amp / Inst. Cluster /
Voltage Regulator 6 amp
Starting Electric
Instrument Cluster Analog Speedo w/ LCD
1.11
GENERAL INFORMATION
MISC. NUMBERS/CHARTS
Standard Torque Specifications
The following torque specifications are to be used as a general guideline. FOR SPECIFIC TORQUE VALUES OF FASTENERS Refer to exploded
views in the appropriate section. There are exceptions in the steering, suspension, and engine sections.
Metric / Torque
6 x 1.0. . . . . . . . . . 72-78 In.lbs. . . . . . . . . . 8 x 1.25 14-18 ft.lbs . . . . 10 x 1.25 26-30 ft.lbs.
SPECIAL TOOLS
Special tools may be required while servicing this vehicle. Some of the tools listed or depicted are mandatory, while other tools maybe
substituted with a similar tool, if available. Polaris recommends the use of Polaris Special Tools when servicing any Polaris product.
Dealers may order special tools through Polaris official tool supplier, SPX Corporation, 1-800-328-6657.
1.12
GENERAL INFORMATION
SAE Tap Drill Sizes Decimal Equivalents
Thread Size/ Drill Size Thread Size / Drill Size 1/64 .................
1/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.0156
.0312 . . 1 mm= .0394"
1
#0-80 3/64 1/2-13 27/64 3/64 ................. .0469
#1-64 53 1/2-20 29/64 1/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0625
#1-72 53 9/16-12 31/64 5/64 ................. .0781 . . 2 mm = .0787"
3/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .0938
#2-56 51 9/16-18 33/64 7/64 ................. .1094 . . 3 mm =.1181"
#2-64 50 5/8-11 17/32 1/8 . . . . . . . . .1250
#3-48 5/64 5/8-18 37/64 9/64 ................. .1406
5/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1563 . . 4 mm = .1575"
#3-56 45 3/4-10 21/32 11/64 ................. .1719
#4-40 43 3/4-16 11/16 3/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1875 . . 5mm= .1969"
13/64 ................. .2031
#4-48 42 7/8-9 49/64
7/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2188
#5-40 38 7/8-14 13/16 15/64 ................. .2344 . . 6 mm = .2362"
#5-44 37 1-8 7/8 1/4 . . . . . . . . .25
17/64 ................. .2656 . . 7 mm = .2756"
#6-32 36 1-12 59/64 9/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2813
#6-40 33 1 1/8-7 63/64 19/64 ................. .2969
#8-32 29 1 1/8-12 1 3/64 5/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3125 . . 8mm= .3150"
21/64 ................. .3281
#8-36 29 1 1/4-7 1 7/64 11/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .3438 . . 9 mm = .3543"
#10-24 24 1 1/4-12 1 11/64 23/64 ................. .3594
#10-32 21 1 1/2-6 1 11/32 3/8 . . . . . . . . .375
25/64 ................. .3906 . . 10 mm = .3937"
#12-24 17 1 1/2-12 1 27/64 13/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .4063
#12-28 4.6mm 1 3/4-5 1 9/16 27/64 ................. .4219 . . 11 mm =.4331"
1/4-20 7 1 3/4-12 1 43/64 7/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4375
29/64 ................. .4531
1/4-28 3 2-4 1/2 1 25/32 15/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .4688 . . 12 mm = .4724"
5/16-18 F 2-12 1 59/64 31/64 ................. .4844
1/2 . . . . . . . . .5. . . . ....... 13mm = .5118"
5/16-24 I 2 1/4-4 1/2 2 1/32
33/64 ................. .5156
3/8-16 O 2 1/2-4 2 1/4 17/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .5313
3/8-24 Q 2 3/4-4 2 1/2 35/64 ................. .5469 . . 14 mm = .5512"
9/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5625
7/16-14 U 3-4 2 3/4 37/64 ................. .5781 . . 15 mm = .5906"
7/16-20 25/64 19/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .5938
39/64 ................. .6094
Metric Tap Drill Sizes 5/8 . . . . . . . . .625. . ....... 16mm=. 6299"
41/64 ................. .6406
21/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .6563 . . 17 mm =.6693"
Tap Size Drill Size Decimal Nearest 43/64 ................. .6719
Equivalent Fraction
11/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . .6875
3x.50 #39 0.0995 3/32 45/64 ................. .7031 . . 18 mm = .7087"
3x.60 3/32 0.0937 3/32 23/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .7188
47/64 ................. .7344 . . 19 mm = .7480"
4x.70 #30 0.1285 1/8
3/4 . . . . . . . . .75
4x.75 1/8 0.125 1/8 49/64 ................. .7656
5x.80 #19 0.166 11/64 25/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .7813 . . 20 mm = .7874"
51/64 ................. .7969
5x.90 #20 0.161 5/32 13/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . .8125 . . 21 mm =.8268"
6x1.00 #9 0.196 13/64 53/64 ................. .8281
7x1.00 16/64 0.234 15/64 27/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .8438
55/64 ................. .8594 . . 22 mm = .8661"
8x1.00 J 0.277 9/32 7/8 . . . . . . . . .875
8x1.25 17/64 0.265 17/64 57/64 ................. .8906 . . 23 mm = .9055"
9x1.00 5/16 0.3125 5/16 29/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .9063
59/64 ................. .9219
9x1.25 5/16 0.3125 5/16 15/16 . . . . . . . . . . . . .9375 . . 24 mm = .9449"
10x1.25 11/32 0.3437 11/32 61/64 ................. .9531
31/32 . . . . . . . . . . . . .9688 . . 25 mm = .9843"
10x1.50 R 0.339 11/32 63/64 ................. .9844
11x1.50 3/8 0.375 3/8 1. . . . . . . . . . 1.0
12x1.50 13/32 0.406 13/32
12x1.75 13/32 0.406 13/32
1.13
GENERAL INFORMATION
Conversion Table
C to F: 9 (C + 40) 5 - 40 = F
F to C: 5 (F + 40) 9 - 40 = C
1.14
GENERAL INFORMATION
Glossary Of Terms
ABDC: After bottom dead center.
ACV: Alternating current voltage.
1
ADC: Active Descent Control. Engages front wheels for 4-wheel EBS.
Alternator: Electrical generator producing voltage alternating current.
ATDC: After top dead center.
BBDC: Before bottom dead center.
BDC: Bottom dead center.
BTDC: Before top dead center.
CC: Cubic centimeters.
Center Distance: Distance between center of crankshaft and center of driven clutch shaft.
Chain Pitch: Distance between chain link pins (No. 35 = 3/8" or 1 cm). Polaris measures chain length in number of pitches.
CI: Cubic inches.
Clutch Buttons: Plastic bushings which aid rotation of the movable sheave in the drive and driven clutch.
Clutch Offset: Drive and driven clutches are offset so that drive belt will stay nearly straight as it moves along the clutch face.
Clutch Weights: Three levers in the drive clutch which relative to their weight, profile and engine RPM cause the drive clutch to close and
grip the drive belt.
Crankshaft Run-Out: Run-out or "bend" of crankshaft measured with a dial indicator while crankshaft is supported between centers on V
blocks or resting in crankcase. Measure at various points especially at PTO.
CVT: Centrifugal Variable Transmission (Drive Clutch System)
DCV: Direct current voltage.
Dial Bore Gauge: A cylinder measuring instrument which uses a dial indicator. Good for showing taper and out-of-round in the cylinder bore.
EBS: Engine Braking System. Uses engine compression to slow the ATV without the use of hydraulic brakes.
Electrical Open: Open circuit. An electrical circuit which isn't complete.
Electrical Short: Short circuit. An electrical circuit which is completed before the current reaches the intended load. (i.e. a bare wire touching
the chassis).
End Seals: Rubber seals at each end of the crankshaft.
Engagement RPM: Engine RPM at which the drive clutch engages to make contact with the drive belt.
ft.: Foot/feet.
Foot Pound: Ft. lb. A force of one pound at the end of a lever one foot in length, applied in a rotational direction.
g: Gram. Unit of weight in the metric system.
gal.: Gallon.
ID: Inside diameter.
in.: Inch/inches.
Inch Pound: In. lb. 12 in. lbs. = 1 ft. lb.
kg/cm2: Kilograms per square centimeter.
kg-m: Kilogram meters.
Kilogram/meter: A force of one kilogram at the end of a lever one meter in length, applied in a rotational direction.
l or ltr: Liter.
lbs/in2: Pounds per square inch.
Left or Right Side: Always referred to based on normal operating position of the driver.
m: Meter/meters.
Mag: Magneto.
Magnetic Induction: As a conductor (coil) is moved through a magnetic field, a voltage will be generated in the windings. Mechanical energy
is converted to electrical energy in the stator.
mi.: Mile/miles.
mm: Millimeter. Unit of length in the metric system. 1 mm = approximately .040".
Nm: Newton meters.
OD: Outside diameter.
Ohm: The unit of electrical resistance opposing current flow.
oz.: Ounce/ounces.
Piston Clearance: Total distance between piston and cylinder wall.
psi.: Pounds per square inch.
PTO: Power take off.
qt.: Quart/quarts.
Regulator: Voltage regulator. Regulates battery charging system output at approximately 14.5 DCV as engine RPM increases.
Reservoir Tank: The fill tank in the liquid cooling system.
Resistance: In the mechanical sense, friction or load. In the electrical sense, ohms, resulting in energy conversion to heat.
RPM: Revolutions per minute.
Seized Piston: Galling of the sides of a piston. Usually there is a transfer of aluminum from the piston onto the cylinder wall.
Possible causes: 1) improper lubrication; 2) excessive temperatures; 3) insufficient piston clearance; 4) stuck piston rings.
Stator Plate: The plate mounted under the flywheel supporting the battery charging coils.
TDC: Top dead center. Piston's most outward travel from crankshaft.
Volt: The unit of measure for electrical pressure of electromotive force. Measured by a voltmeter in parallel with the circuit.
Watt: Unit of electrical power. Watts = amperes x volts.
WOT: Wide open throttle.
1.15
GENERAL INFORMATION
NOTES
1.16
MAINTENANCE
CHAPTER 2
MAINTENANCE
MAINTENANCE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
OVERVIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE CHART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4
2
LUBRICATION / FLUIDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7
GENERAL COMPONENT LOCATIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7
POLARIS LUBRICANTS, MAINTENANCE AND SERVICE PRODUCTS . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8
POLARIS LUBRICANT SYMBOL IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.9
PRE-RIDE / DAILY INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.9
LUBRICATION / GREASE POINTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.10
FRONT GEARCASE LUBRICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.11
TRANSMISSION LUBRICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.12
ADC DIFFERENTIAL HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT FLUID CHANGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.13
VEHICLE INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.13
SHIFT LINK ROD AND THROTTLE INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.13
THROTTLE INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.14
THROTTLE CABLE / ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . 2.14
FUEL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15
VENT LINES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15
COMPRESSION TEST. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15
ENGINE MOUNTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16
SPARK PLUG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16
ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (ADC) RESERVIOR LEVEL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16
BATTERY MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17
COOLING SYSTEM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17
COOLANT STRENGTH / TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
COOLING HOSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
RADIATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
COOLING SYSTEM PRESSURE TEST. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
RESERVOIR LEVEL INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
RADIATOR COOLANT LEVEL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
AIR FILTER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
AIR BOX SEDIMENT TUBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20
ENGINE BREATHER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20
PVT INSPECTION / DRYING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
ENGINE GROUND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
ENGINE OIL LEVEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21
OIL/FILTER CHANGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.22
STEERING INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23
TIE ROD / STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23
CAMBER/CASTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.23
WHEEL ALIGNMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
TOE ALIGNMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
EXHAUST PIPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25
BRAKE SYSTEM INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25
BRAKE PADS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26
BRAKE HOSE INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26
AUXILIARY (REAR) BRAKE TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26
AUXILIARY BRAKE ADJUSTMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
SUSPENSION: SPRING PRELOAD ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
FRONT SUSPENSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
REAR SUSPENSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
CV SHAFT BOOT INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
ATV CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
WHEEL INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
2.1
MAINTENANCE
WHEEL REMOVAL: FRONT OR REAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
WHEEL INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
TIRE PRESSURE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
TIRE INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
FRAME, NUTS, BOLTS, FASTENERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
FRONT / REAR STORAGE COMPARTMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
WARNWINCH OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30
CLEANING AND STORAGE OF ATV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.32
2.2
MAINTENANCE
MAINTENANCE
Overview
Careful periodic maintenance will help keep your vehicle in the safest, most reliable condition. Inspection, adjustment and
lubrication of important components are explained in the periodic maintenance chart.
Inspect, clean, lubricate, adjust and replace parts as necessary. When inspection reveals the need for replacement parts, use genuine
Polaris parts available from your Polaris dealer.
2
NOTE: Service and adjustments are critical. If you're not familiar with safe service and adjustment procedures, have a qualified
dealer perform these operations.
Maintenance intervals in the following chart are based upon average riding conditions and an average vehicle speed of approximately
10 miles per hour. Vehicles subjected to severe use must be inspected and serviced more frequently.
Frequent immersion in mud, water or sand
Racing or race-style high RPM use
Prolonged low speed, heavy load operation
Extended idle
Short trip cold weather operation
Pay special attention to the oil level. A rise in oil level during cold weather can indicate contaminants collecting in the oil sump or
crankcase. Change oil immediately if the oil level begins to rise. Monitor the oil level, and if it continues to rise, discontinue use
and determine the cause.
= CAUTION: Due to the nature of these adjustments, it is recommended this service be performed by an authorized
Polaris dealer.
= SEVERE USE ITEM --If vehicle is subjected to severe use, decrease interval by 50% (Severe Use is defined as frequent
vehicle immersion in mud, water or sand, racing or race-style high rpm use, prolonged low speed - heavy load operation or
extended idle. More preventative maintenance is required under these conditions. Fluid changes, cable, chain and chassis
lubrication are required more frequently. For engine oil, short trip cold weather riding also constitutes severe use. Pay
special attention to oil level. A rising oil level in cold weather can indicate contaminants collecting in the oil sump or
crankcase. Change oil immediately and monitor level. If oil level begins to rise, discontinue use and determine cause.)
E = Emission Control System Service (California).
NOTE: Inspection may reveal the need for replacement parts. Always use genuine Polaris parts.
WARNING: Improperly performing the procedures marked with a could result in component failure and lead to serious injury
or death. Have an authorized Polaris dealer perform these services.
2.3
MAINTENANCE
Periodic Maintenance Chart
Steering -- Pre-Ride --
Tires -- Pre-Ride --
Wheels/Fasteners -- Pre-Ride --
Air filter,
, E -- Daily -- Inspect; clean often
pre-filter
Coolant
-- Daily -- Check level daily, change coolant every 2 years
(if applicable)
Head lamp/tail
-- Daily -- Check operation; apply dielectric grease if replacing
lamp
= Perform these procedures more often for vehicles subjected to severe use.
2.4
MAINTENANCE
Table 2-1: REQUIRED MAINTENANCE INTERVALS
Engine breather
, E filter (if 25 H Monthly 155 (250) Inspect; replace if necessary
equipped)
General
50 H 3M 310 (500) Lubricate all fittings, pivots, cables, etc.
lubrication
Throttle Cable/
,E 50 H 6M 310 (500) Inspect; adjust; lubricate; replace if necessary
ETC Switch
E Air intake ducts 50 H 6M 310 (500) Inspect ducts for proper sealing/air leaks
Engine Oil
, E 100 H 6M 620 (1000) Perform a break-in oil change at 25 hours/one month
Change
, E Oil filter change 100 H 6M 620 (1000) Replace with oil change
= Perform these procedures more often for vehicles subjected to severe use.
2.5
MAINTENANCE
Table 2-1: REQUIRED MAINTENANCE INTERVALS
Radiator
100 H 12 M 620 (1000) Inspect; clean external surfaces
(if applicable)
Cooling hoses
100 H 12 M 620 (1000) Inspect for leaks
(if applicable)
Exhaust
100 H 12 M 620 (1000) Inspect
muffler/pipe
Clutches
100 H 12 M 620 (1000) Inspect; clean; replace worn parts
(drive & driven)
1240
Brake fluid 200 H 24 M Change every two years
(1000)
1240
ADC fluid 200 H 24 M Change every two years
(1000)
1860
Spark arrestor 300 H 36 M Clean out
(3000)
Toe Adjustment ---- Inspect periodically; adjust when parts are replaced
,
Auxiliary brake ---- Inspect daily, adjust as needed
= Perform these procedures more often for vehicles subjected to severe use.
2.6
MAINTENANCE
LUBRICATION / FLUIDS
SPORTSMAN Component Locations
(Deluxe)
(Sportsman Only)
2.7
MAINTENANCE
SPORTSMAN X2 Component Locations
Instrument Cluster AWD/Turf Switch
Brake Fluid Reservoir Worklight (Speedometer)
Brake Lever
Front Demand
Drive Unit Rear Dump Box / Passenger Area
(Behind Radiator)
Muffler
Transmission
Auxiliary Brake
2.8
MAINTENANCE
Polaris Lubricants, Maintenance and Service Table 2-2:
Products
PART
DESCRIPTION
Table 2-2: NUMBER
Coolant
PART
DESCRIPTION 2871323 60/40 Coolant (Gallon) (6 count)
NUMBER
Engine Lubricant
2871534 60/40 Coolant (Quart) (12 count) 2
Additives / Sealants / Thread Locking Agents / Misc.
2870791 Fogging Oil (12 oz. Aerosol)
2874275 Loctite Primer N, Aerosol
Engine Oil (Quart) Premium Synthetic
2871281
0W-40 (4-cycle) (12 count) Loctite Thread Sealant 565
2871956
Engine Oil (Gallon) Premium Synthetic (50 ml.) (6 count)
2871844
0W-40 (4-cycle) (4 count) Loctite Threadlock 242
2871950
Engine Oil (16 Gallon) Premium 4 (6 ml.) (12 count)
2871567
Synthetic 0W-40 (4-cycle) Loctite Threadlock 262
2871951
Gearcase / Transmission Lubricants (50 ml.) (10 count)
2876251 Demand Drive LT Premium Hub Fluid Loctite Threadlock 271
2871953
3234438 Polaris ADC Hydraulic Fluid (6 ml.) (12 count)
Premium Synthetic AGL Gearcase Lube 3-Bond 1215 Sealant
2873602 2871557
(12 oz. bottle) (12 count) (5 oz.)
Premium Synthetic AGL Gearcase Lube Premium Carbon Clean
2873603 2871326
(1 Gal. bottle) (4 count) (12 oz.) (12 count)
Premium ATV Angle Drive Fluid 2870652 Fuel Stabilizer (16 oz.) (12 count)
2876160
(32 oz.) (12 count)
Black RTV Silicone Sealer
Premium ATV Angle Drive Fluid 2871957
2872276 (3 oz. tube ) (12 count)
(2.5 Gal.) (2 count)
Black RTV Silicone Sealer
2870465 Oil Pump for 1 Gallon Jug 2871958
(11 oz. cartridge) (12 count)
Grease / Specialized Lubricants 2870990 DOT 3 Brake Fluid (12 count)
Premium All Season Grease 2871557 Crankcase Sealant, 3 Bond 1215 (5 oz.)
2871322
(3 oz. cartridge) (24 count)
Premium All Season Grease
2871423
(14 oz. cartridge) (10 count)
2871460 Starter Drive Grease (12 count)
Premium U-Joint Lube
2871515
(3 oz.) (24 Count)
Premium U-Joint Lube
2871551
(14 oz.) (10 count)
2871312 Grease Gun Kit
2871329 Dielectric Grease (Nyogel)
2.9
MAINTENANCE
Polaris Lubricant Symbol Identification Pre-Ride / Daily Inspection
NOTE: The symbols used are for quick reference in identifying Perform the following pre-ride inspection daily, and when
which lubricant/grease to use on each component. servicing the vehicle at each scheduled maintenance.
Tires - check tire condition and air pressures
Fuel and oil - fill both to their proper level; Do not
overfill
All brakes - check operation and adjustment (includes
auxiliary brake)
Polaris DOT
Brake Fluid Polaris Synthetic AGL Throttle -check for free operation
Gearcase Lube
Headlight/Taillight/Brakelight - check operation of all
Polaris ADC indicator lights and switches
Hydraulic Fluid
Engine stop switch - check for proper function
Wheels - check for loose wheel nuts and axle nuts;
check to be sure axle nuts are secured by cotter pins
Polaris Synthetic Polaris 60/40 Air cleaner element - check for dirt or water; clean or
0W/40 Coolant replace
Steering - check for free operation, noting any unusual
looseness in any area
Loose parts - visually inspect vehicle for any damaged
or loose nuts, bolts or fasteners
Polaris ATV Angle Demand Drive LT Engine coolant - check for proper level at the recovery
Drive Fluid Premium Hub Fluid bottle
ADC Fluid Level - check for proper level
2.10
MAINTENANCE
Lubrication / Grease Points
1. Engine Oil 2. Transmission Fluid 4. Rear Gearcase
2
6. Front A-Arm
3. Front Gearcase
5. Brake Fluid
8. Front Propshaft
7. Rear A-Arm
* Perform more often under severe use, such as operation in water and under severe loads.
Semi-annually or 50 hours of operation 9refer to Maintenance Schedule for additional information). More often under severe
conditions (operating in water or hauling heavy loads.
Annually or 100 hours of operation (refer to Maintenance Schedule for additional information). More often under severe
conditions (operating in water or hauling heavy loads.
Grease conforming to NLGI No. 2, such as Polaris Premium All Season Grease, Conoco Superlube M, or Mobilgrease Special
2.11
MAINTENANCE
Front Gearcase Lubrication To Change Gearcase Lubricant:
FRONT GEARCASE
Drain Plug
Fill Plug
=
Specified Lubricant:
Demand Drive LT Premium Hub Fluid
2.12
MAINTENANCE
Transmission Lubrication
The (transmission) lubricant level should be checked and =
changed in accordance with the maintenance schedule.
Be sure vehicle is level and in Park before proceeding. Transmission - Specified Lubricant:
Polaris AGL Gearcase Lubricant
Check vent hose to be sure it is routed properly and
unobstructed.
(Gallon - PN 2873603) (12 oz. - PN 2873602)
2
Follow instructions to check / change transmission Sportsman - Capacity: 15 oz. (450 ml)
lubricant. Sportsman X2 - Capacity: 32 oz. (948 ml)
=T
Transmission
Sportsman - Drain / Fill Plug Torque:
14 ft.lbs. (19 Nm)
To Change Lubricant:
1. Remove transmission drain plug to drain the oil. Discard
used oil properly.
2. Clean and reinstall the drain plug. Torque to specification.
3. Remove fill plug.
4. Add the correct amount of Polaris AGL Gearcase
Lubricant.
5. Check for leaks.
Oil Fill Plug 6. Install fill plug. Torque to specification.
2.13
MAINTENANCE
ADC Differential Hydraulic Circuit Fluid VEHICLE INSPECTION
Change
1. Make sure vehicle is parked on flat ground and allowed to
Shift Link Rod Inspection
sit at least 30 minutes prior to bleeding hydraulic circuit. NOTE: Shift rod is preset at time of manufacturer.
2. Thoroughly clean area around and on remote reservoir and
bleeder valves. 1. Inspect shift link tie rod ends and replace if worn or
3. Remove reservoir cap and diaphragm assembly. damaged. Lubricate pivot points with a light aerosol
4. Make sure hydraulic oil inside reservoir is free of debris. lubricant or grease if desired.
If any debris is found, use clean rag or suction device to
remove from the reservoir.
NOTE: Debris in reservoir may block porting and
produce inadequate bleeding of the system.
Decreased performance may be encountered with
inadequate bleed of the hydraulic circuit. Shift Mount
=T
Bleeder Valve Torque:
80 in. lbs. (9 Nm)
2.14
MAINTENANCE
Throttle Inspection Throttle Cable / Electronic Throttle Control
(ETC Switch) Adjustment
Check for smooth throttle opening and closing in all handlebar
positions. Throttle lever operation should be smooth and lever 1. Slide boot off throttle cable adjuster and jam nut.
must return freely without binding.
2. Place shift selector in neutral and set parking brake.
1. Place the gear selector in neutral. 3. Loosen lock nut on in-line cable adjuster (Ill. 1).
2.
3.
Place shift selector in neutral and set parking brake.
Loosen lock nut on in-line cable adjuster (Ill. 1). Boot
2
Boot
4. Turn handlebars from full right to full left. If idle speed Adjuster Sleeve Lock Nut
increases at any point in the turning range, inspect throttle
cable routing and condition. Adjust cable tension as needed
until lock-to-lock turning can be accomplished with no rise
in engine rpm.
5. Replace the throttle cable if worn, kinked, or damaged.
Direction of Travel
ETC Cover
Removal Sequence 1/16-1/8 Freeplay
= In. / mm.
Throttle Freeplay:
.0625 - .1250" (1.58 - 3.17mm)
2.15
MAINTENANCE
Fuel System 4. Remove fuel lines from filter, use shop towels to catch any
leaking fuel.
5. Install new filter in line with arrow pointed in direction of
WARNING fuel flow.
6. Install line locks on fuel lines and verify locks are seated.
* Gasoline is extremely flammable and explosive 7. Start engine and inspect for leaks.
under certain conditions.
* EFI components are under high pressure. Verify
Vent Lines
system pressure has been relieved before
disassembly. Check fuel tank, oil tank, battery and transmission vent lines for
* Never drain the fuel system when the engine is signs of wear, deterioration, damage or leakage. Replace Be
hot. Severe burns may result sure vent lines are routed properly and secured with cable ties.
* Do not overfill the tank. The tank is at full capacity
when the fuel reaches the bottom of the filler neck.
CAUTION
Leave room for expansion of fuel.
* Never start the engine or let it run in an enclosed
area. Gasoline powered engine exhaust fumes are Verify vent lines are not kinked or damaged
poisonous and can cause loss of consciousness
and death in a short time. Compression Test
* Do not smoke or allow open flames or sparks in NOTE: This engine does NOT have decompression
or near the area where refueling is performed or components. Compression readings will vary in
where gasoline is stored. proportion to cranking speed during the test.
* If you get gasoline in your eyes or if you should Average compression (measured) is about 150-200
swallow gasoline, seek medical attention psi during a compression test.
immediately.
* If you spill gasoline on your skin or clothing, A smooth idle generally indicates good compression. Low
immediately wash with soap and water and change engine compression is rarely a factor in running condition
clothing. problems above idle speed. Abnormally high compression can
be caused by carbon deposits in the combustion chamber or
* Always stop the engine and refuel outdoors or in worn, damaged exhaust cam lobes. Inspect camshaft and
a well ventilated area.Keep away from open flames combustion chamber if compression is abnormally high.
and electrical components when removing fuel
A cylinder leakdown test is the best indication of engine
filter. condition. Follow manufacturer's instructions to perform a
cylinder leakage test. (Never use high pressure leakage testers,
The fuel filter (1) should be replaced in accordance with the as crankshaft seals may dislodge and leak).
Periodic Maintenance Chart. To replace the filter:
Cylinder Compression
EFI Example Standard: 150-200 PSI
(1)
Cylinder Leakdown
Service Limit 15%
2.16
MAINTENANCE
Engine Mounts 5. Measure gap with a wire gauge. Refer to specifications for
proper spark plug type and gap. Adjust gap if necessary by
Inspect rubber engine mounts (A) for cracks or damage. bending the side electrode carefully.
Check engine fasteners and mounts, ensure they are tight.
Spark Plug Gap
CAUTION
CAUTION
2.17
MAINTENANCE
Battery Maintenance To Remove the Battery:
Complete battery servicing information for both conventional 1. Disconnect holder strap and remove cover.
and sealed batteries can be found in Chapter 10 of this 2. Disconnect battery negative (-) (black) cable first, followed
manual. by the positive (+) (red) cable.
WARNING CAUTION
Battery electrolyte is poisonous. It contains sulfuric To reduce the chance of sparks: Whenever
acid. Serious burns can result from contact with removing the battery, disconnect the negative
skin, eyes or clothing. Antidote: (black) cable first. When reinstalling the battery,
install the negative cable last.
External: Flush with water.
3. Disconnect the vent hose.
Internal: Drink large quantities of water or milk.
Follow with milk of magnesia, beaten egg, or 4. Remove the battery.
vegetable oil. Call physician immediately. 5. (Conventional Battery Only) Remove the filler caps and
add distilled water only as needed to bring each cell to the
Eyes: Flush with water for 15 minutes and get
prompt medical attention. proper level. Do not overfill the battery.
IMPORTANT: Use only distilled water. Tap water
Batteries produce explosive gases. Keep sparks, contains minerals which are harmful to a battery.
flame, cigarettes, etc. away. Ventilate when
charging or using in an enclosed space. Always IMPORTANT: Do not allow cleaning solution or tap
shield eyes when working near batteries. water to enter a battery, as it will shorten the life of the
KEEP OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN. battery.
6. Fully recharge the battery.
NOTE: Expected battery shelf life is 6-8 months 7. Reinstall battery caps (Conventional Battery Only).
depending on storage conditions. As a general rule 8. Clean battery cables and terminals with a stiff wire brush.
before placing the battery into service, check the Corrosion can be removed using a solution of one cup water
battery condition and charge accordingly. and one tablespoon baking soda. Rinse well with clean
NOTE: New Batteries: Batteries must be fully water and dry thoroughly.
charged before use or battery life will be reduced by 9. Reinstall battery, attaching positive (+) (red) cable first and
10-30% of full potential. Charge battery for 3-5 hours then the negative (-) (black) cable.
at a current equivalent of 1/10 of the battery's rated 10. Reattach vent hose making sure it is properly routed and not
amp/hour capacity. Do not use the alternator to kinked or pinched.
charge a new battery. (Refer to battery video PN 11. Coat terminals and bolt threads with Dielectric Grease (PN
9917987). 2871329).
(Conventional Battery Only) Inspect the battery fluid level. 12. Reinstall battery cover and holder strap.
When the electrolyte nears the lower level, remove the battery
and add distilled water only to the upper level line . Cooling System
The engine coolant level is controlled or maintained by the
recovery system. The recovery system components are the
recovery bottle, radiator filler neck, radiator pressure cap and
connecting hose.
Maintain between
upper and lower As coolant operating temperature increases, the expanding
level marks (heated) excess coolant is forced out of the radiator past the
pressure cap and into the recovery bottle. As engine coolant
temperature decreases the contracting (cooled) coolant is drawn
back up from the tank past the pressure cap and into the radiator.
Some coolant level drop on new machines is normal as
the system is purging itself of trapped air. Observe
coolant levels often during the break-in period.
Overheating of engine could occur if air is not fully
purged from system.
Polaris Premium 60/40 anti-freeze is premixed and
ready to use. Do not dilute with water.
2.18
MAINTENANCE
Coolant Strength / Type Radiator
Test the strength of the coolant using an antifreeze 1. Check radiator external air flow passages for restrictions or
hydrometer. damage.
2. Carefully straighten any bent radiator fins.
3. Remove any obstructions with compressed air or low
pressure water.
2
Cooling System Pressure Test
See Chapter 3 for pressure test procedures.
Recovery Bottle
2.19
MAINTENANCE
Radiator Coolant Level 3. Remove clips (A) from air box cover and remove cover.
Inspect the gasket. It should adhere tightly to the cover and
seal all the way around.
WARNING
NOTE: Use of a non-standard pressure cap will not 4. Loosen clamp and remove air filter assembly.
allow the recovery system to function properly.
Cover
To Access the Radiator Pressure Cap:
Lift the front cargo cover. Remove access cover (A) by placing Seal
your fingers under the front of the cover and pulling upward.
The radiator cap (B) is now accessible.
Pre-filter
Main Element
A
Cleaning:
B
5. Slip the pre-filter element off of main element. Clean the
pre filter with hot soapy water.
6. Rinse and dry thoroughly.
7. Inspect element for tears or damage.
Air Filter Service 8. Inspect main filter and replace if necessary. If the filter has
It is recommended that the air filter and pre filter be replaced been soaked with fuel or oil it must be replaced.
annually. When riding in extremely dusty conditions,
replacement is required more often. Installation:
The pre filter should be cleaned before each ride using the 9. Reinstall pre-filter element over main filter. Be sure the
following procedure: element covers entire surface of main filter without folds,
1. Lift up on the rear of the seat. creases, or gaps.
2. Pull the seat back and free of the tabs. 10. Reinstall filter on main filter mount. Place filter clamp over
NOTE: When reinstalling seat, make sure the slots the assembly and tighten.
in the seat engage the tabs in the fuel tank.
2.20
MAINTENANCE
NOTE: Apply a small amount of general purpose NOTE: The sediment tube will require more frequent
grease to the sealing edges of the filter before service if the vehicle is operated in wet conditions or
reinstalling. at high throttle openings for extended periods.
A
2
B
A
To Cylinder
Head Cover
Front of ATV
2.21
MAINTENANCE
PVT Inspection / Drying Procedure Engine Oil Level
NOTE: If operating the ATV in or through water, be The twin engine is a wet-sump engine, meaning the oil is
sure to check the PVT cover and other components contained in the bottom of the crankcase. To check the oil level:
for water ingestion. The ATV should be checked
immediately.
Dipstick
A
A
2. To further expel water from the cover and to dry out the
PVT system, shift the transmission to neutral and rev
engine slightly to expel the moisture and air-dry the belt and
clutches. Allow engine RPM to settle to idle speed, shift
transmission to lowest available range and test for belt
slippage. Operate ATV in lowest available range for a short
period of time until PVT system is dry.
Engine Ground
Inspect engine-to-frame ground cable connection. Be sure the 3. Unlock the lever lock (A). Remove dipstick (B) and wipe
connection clean and tight. dry with a clean cloth.
A
B
2.22
MAINTENANCE
4. Reinstall dipstick and push it into place. Do not lock the Oil/filter Change
dipstick.
1. Place vehicle on a level surface.
NOTE: Make certain the dipstick is inserted all the
2. Run engine two to three minutes until warm. Stop engine.
way into the filler tube to keep the angle and depth of
stick consistent. When reinstalling the dipstick, 3. Clean area around drain plug at bottom of engine.
make certain to seat the lever lock. 4. Place a drain pan beneath crankcase and remove drain plug.
5. Remove dipstick and check to see that the oil level is in the CAUTION
2
normal range. Add oil as indicated by the level on the
dipstick. Do not overfill. (See NOTE below!) Do not allow hot oil to come into contact
NOTE: Due to the dipstick entry angle into the with your skin, as serious burns may result.
crankcase, the oil level will read higher on the
bottom side of the dipstick. Proper level indication 5. Allow oil to drain completely.
is determined on the upper side of the dipstick as it 6. Replace the sealing washer on drain plug.
is being removed, regardless of the level marks NOTE: The sealing surfaces on drain plug and oil
being on top or on bottom. (See illustration) tank should be clean and free of burrs, nicks or
scratches.
=T
Always read top side of dipstick to Drain Plug Torque:
properly check oil level in crankcase.
15 2 ft.lbs. (21.7 2.7 Nm)
2.23
MAINTENANCE
14. Start the engine and let it idle for one to two minutes. Stop Tie Rod / Steering
the engine and inspect for leaks.
To check for play in the tie rod end, grasp the steering
15. Re-check the oil level on the dipstick and add oil as tie rod, pull in all directions feeling for movement.
necessary to bring the level to the upper mark on the
dipstick. Repeat inspection for inner tie rod end on steering post.
16. Dispose of used filter and oil properly.
Camber/Caster
Camber and caster are non-adjustable.
2.24
MAINTENANCE
Wheel Alignment Toe Alignment
1. Place machine on a smooth level surface. If toe alignment is incorrect, measure the distance between
2. Set handlebars in a straight ahead position and secure vehicle center and each wheel. This will tell you which tie rod
needs adjusting.
handlebars in this position.
3. Place a chalk mark on the center line of the front tires NOTE: Be sure handlebars are straight ahead before
approximately 10, (25.4 cm) from the floor or as close to
the hub/axle center line as possible.
determining which tie rod(s) need adjustment.
2
NOTE: It is important that the height of both marks
be equally positioned in order to get an accurate
CAUTION
measurement.
During tie rod adjustment, it is very important that
4. Measure the distance between the marks and record the the following precautions be taken when tightening
measurement. Call this measurement A. tie rod end jam nuts. If the rod end is positioned
5. Rotate the tires 180 by moving vehicle forward or incorrectly it will not pivot, and may break.
backward. Position chalk marks facing rearward, even with
the hub/axle centerline. To Adjust Toe Alignment:
6. Again measure the distance between the marks and record. Hold tie rod end to keep it from rotating.
Call this measurement B. Subtract measurement B
from measurement A. The difference between Loosen jam nuts at both end of the tie rod.
measurements A and B is the vehicle toe alignment. Shorten or lengthen the tie rod until alignment is as
The recommended vehicle toe tolerance is 1/8, to 1/4, (.3 required to achieve the proper toe setting as specified
to .6 cm) toe out. This means the measurement at the front
IMPORTANT: When tightening the tie rod end jam
of the tire (A) is 1/8, to 1/4, (.3 to .6 cm) wider than the nuts, the rod ends must be held parallel to prevent rod
measurement at the rear (B). end damage and premature wear. Damage may not be
immediately apparent if done incorrectly. See
illustration above.
After alignment is complete, torque jam nuts to
specification.
Hold Rod
End
= In. / mm.
=T
Wheel Toe-Out: Tie Rod Jam Nut Torque:
(A) - (B) = 1/8 - 1/4" (.3 to .6 cm) 12-14 ft. lbs. (16-19 Nm)
2.25
MAINTENANCE
Exhaust Pipe 6. Repeat Steps 2 through 5 until no more particles are
expelled when the engine is revved.
The exhaust pipe must be periodically purged of accumulated
carbon as follows: 7. Stop the engine and allow the arrestor to cool.
8. Reinstall the clean out plugs.
1. Remove the clean out plugs located on the bottom of the
muffler as shown WARNING
2.26
MAINTENANCE
Inspect thickness of brake pad friction material (see Brake Hose Inspection
Chapter 9)
Check brake system hoses and fittings for cracks, deterioration,
Sight Glass abrasion, and leaks. Tighten any loose fittings and replace any
worn or damaged parts.
Brake Pad
Measure Thickness
2.27
MAINTENANCE
2. While turning the rear wheels by hand, apply the auxiliary Bleeding:
foot brake. This brake should not stop the wheels from
If free play is correct and brake pedal travel is still excessive, air
turning until the lever is half way between its rest position may be trapped somewhere in the system. Bleed the hydraulic
and bottoming on the footrest. auxiliary brake system in a conventional manner, following the
procedure outlined in Brake Chapter 9.
Auxiliary Foot Brake
Suspension: Spring Preload Adjustment
Pedal - Full Height
Operator weight and vehicle loading affect suspension spring
Full Engagement preload requirements. Adjust as necessary. Use Shock Spanner
Wrench (PN 2870872) to adjust the rear springs.
Front Suspension
Compress and release front suspension. Dampening
should be smooth throughout the range of travel.
Floor Board Surface Check all front suspension components for wear or
damage.
Inspect front strut cartridges for leakage.
Use the following procedure to inspect the hydraulic auxiliary Compress and release rear suspension. Dampening
(foot) brake system and adjust or bleed if necessary: should be smooth throughout the range of travel.
First, check foot brake effectiveness by applying 50 lb. Check all rear suspension components for wear or
(approx.) downward force on the pedal. The top of the pedal damage.
should be at least 1 inch, (25.4mm) above the surface of the
footrest. Inspect shock for leakage.
Floorboard
INSPECT BOOTS
= In. / mm.
2.28
MAINTENANCE
ATV Controls 3. Elevate the side of the vehicle by placing a suitable stand
under the footrest frame.
Check controls for proper operation, positioning and
adjustment.
Brake control and switch must be positioned to allow brake
lever to travel throughout entire range without contacting switch
body.
2
Wheel Installation
1. With the transmission in park and the parking brake
locked, place the wheel in the correct position on the wheel
hub. Be sure the valve stem is toward the outside and
rotation arrows on the tire point toward forward rotation.
2. Attach the wheel nuts and finger tighten them.
3. Lower the vehicle to the ground.
Wheel Inspection 4. Securely tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque listed
Inspect all wheels for runout or damage. Check wheel nuts and in the table .
ensure they are tight. Do not over tighten the wheel nuts.
Steel Wheel Aluminum Wheel
Item Specification
Steel - Front and Rear 27 ft.lbs. (37 Nm)
Wheel Nuts
Aluminum - Front and Rear 90 ft.lbs. (122 Nm)
Wheel Nuts
Front Hub Retaining Nut 70 ft.lbs. (90 Nm)
Rear Hub Retaining Nut 80 ft.lbs. (108 Nm)
CAUTION
4Wheel Nuts
Improperly installed wheels could affect vehicle
handling and tire wear. On vehicles with tapered
rear wheel nuts, make sure tapered end of nut goes
into taper on wheel. Torque to proper specification.
Retaining Nut
1. Stop the engine, place the transmission in gear and lock the
parking brake.
2. Loosen the wheel nuts slightly.
2.29
MAINTENANCE
Tire Pressure Front / Rear Storage Compartments
The front and rear storage (Sportsman Only) compartments are
CAUTION easily accessible. To open the front compartment turn the latch
handle to the horizontal position on both sides. To close the
storage compartment turn the latch handles to the vertical
Maintain proper tire pressure. Refer to the warning position.
tire pressure decal applied to the vehicle.
Table 2-1:
TIRE PRESSURE INSPECTION (PSI - COLD)
Front Rear
5 5
Tire Inspection
Improper tire inflation may affect ATV
maneuverability. Front Storage - Unlatched
When replacing a tire always use original equipment
size and type.
The use of non-standard size or type tires may affect
ATV handling.
Tire Tread Depth
Always replace tires when tread depth is worn to 1/8, (3 mm) or
less.
Tread Depth - 1/8 (3 mm)
WARNING
2.30
MAINTENANCE
Winch Operation (If Equipped) The mini-rocker (IN/OUT) control controls the direction of the
cable for the winch. IN pulls the cable into the winch and OUT
This information is for Sportsman models equipped with a feeds the cable out of the winch.
winch in the front.
Winch Control
The winch control located on the side of the winch gives the
operator easy access to switch between ENGAGED and
FREESPOOL.
When the winch is ENGAGED, the winch only allows the cable
to be pulled IN or released OUT via the mini-rocker switch on
the handlebar.
When the winch is FREESPOOL, the winch allows the cable to
be pulled out freely.
Winch Handlebar Controls
NOTE: The switch on the handlebar does not have to be in
The winch is located in the front bumper area. the OUT position.
LFREESPOOL
ENGAGE
2.31
MAINTENANCE
Winch Wire Locations Locate the Red wire (6 Ga.) with the yellow crimp cover is
located in the rear fender area. The red wire connects to the
The winch wires can be located under the front cab area. Locate battery.
the wires, remove the cap and hook up to winch the Blue and
Yellow (6 Ga.) wires to the winch. Refer to the installation
instructions for more details.
2.32
MAINTENANCE
Cleaning And Storage Of ATV Clean the Exterior
Cleaning the ATV Make necessary repairs and then clean the ATV thoroughly with
mild soap and warm water to remove all dirt and grime. Don't
Keeping your ATV clean will not only improve its appearance use harsh detergents or high pressure washers. Some detergents
but it can also extend the life of various components. With a few deteriorate rubber parts. Use dish soap type cleaners only. High
precautions, your ATV can be cleaned much like an automobile. pressure washers may force water past seals.
2.33
MAINTENANCE
6. After storage procedures are complete, do not start the Transporting the ATV
engine until unit is ready to be removed from storage.
Follow these procedures when transporting the vehicle:
Starting the engine will remove the protective coating from
the engine components. 1. Turn off the engine and remove the key to prevent loss
during transporting.
Lubrication 2. Always place the transmission in park and lock the parking
Inspect all cables and lubricate with Polaris Cable Lubricant. brake.
Follow lubrication guidelines in the maintenance section of the 3. Be sure the fuel cap, oil cap and seat are installed correctly.
service or owner's manual to completely grease and lubricate the
entire vehicle with Polaris Premium All Season Grease. 4. Always tie the frame of the ATV to the transporting unit
securely using suitable straps or rope.
Battery Storage
Remove the battery from the vehicle and ensure that it's fully
charged before placing it in storage. See Chapter 10 for
instructions.
Engine Anti-Freeze
Test engine coolant strength and change if necessary. Coolant
should be replaced every two years.
Storage Area / Covers
Set the tire pressure and safely support the ATV with the tires 1-
2" off the ground. Be sure the storage area is well ventilated, and
cover the machine with a genuine Polaris ATV cover.
NOTE: Do not use plastic or coated materials. They
do not allow enough ventilation to prevent
condensation, and may promote corrosion and
oxidation.
2.34
MAINTENANCE
800 EFI Dual Exhaust Canister Maintenance
(Sportsman Only)
The canisters on select dual exhaust Polaris Sportsman 800 EFIs
(X2 not applicable) are silver ceramic coated. To maintain a
beautiful finish and prevent corrosion, periodic maintenance is
required.
CAUTION
2
DO NOT use caustic chemicals to clean, as they
may damage the finish.
2.35
MAINTENANCE
Maintenance Schedule
2.36
ENGINE
CHAPTER 3
ENGINE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2
CRANKCASE EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2
ENGINE FASTENER TORQUE PATTERNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.9
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.10
700/800 EFI ENGINE SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.13
GENERAL ENGINE SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
ACCESSIBLE COMPONENTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
PISTON IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
3
COOLING SYSTEM SPECIFICATIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
COOLING SYSTEM PRESSURE TEST. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15
FOUR STROKE - COOLANT AIR BLEEDING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15
ENGINE REMOVAL (TYPICAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.16
ENGINE INSTALLATION NOTES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.17
CYLINDER HONE SELECTION AND HONING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18
HONING TO DEGLAZE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18
CLEANING THE CYLINDER AFTER HONING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.18
OIL FLOW CHART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.19
ENGINE LUBRICATION SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.19
OIL PRESSURE TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.19
ENGINE DISASSEMBLY AND INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.20
CYLINDER HEAD ASSEMBLY EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.20
ROCKER ARMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.21
PUSH RODS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.21
CYLINDER HEAD REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.21
CYLINDER HEAD INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.22
CYLINDER HEAD WARP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.22
VALVE SEAL/SPRING SERVICE
(ON ENGINE)3.22
CYLINDER HEAD DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.23
VALVE INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.24
COMBUSTION CHAMBER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.25
VALVE SEAT RECONDITIONING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.25
CYLINDER HEAD REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.27
VALVE SEALING TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.28
CYLINDER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.28
VALVE LIFTER REMOVAL/INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.28
PISTON REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.29
CYLINDER INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.30
PISTON-TO-CYLINDER CLEARANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.31
PISTON/ROD INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.31
PISTON RING INSTALLED GAP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
STARTER DRIVE/BENDIX REMOVAL INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
FLYWHEEL / STATOR REMOVAL / INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.33
ENGINE CRANKCASE DISASSEMBLY / INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.34
CAMSHAFT INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.41
ENGINE REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.42
CRANKCASE REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.42
FLYWHEEL / STATOR INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.53
CYLINDER HEAD REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.54
TROUBLESHOOTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.56
ENGINE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.56
COOLING SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.57
800 EFI EXHAUST SYSTEM (DELUXE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.58
DUAL EXHAUST LAYOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.58
3.1
ENGINE
SPECIFICATIONS
Crankcase Exploded Views
A. JournalBearings
B. Camshaft
C. Thrust Plate
D. Balance Shaft
E. Woodruff Key
F. Flange Seal
G. Crankshaft B
H. Oil Pickup
I. Journal Bearings
J. Baffle
K. Oil Plug C
L. Washer A
M. O-ring
N. Crankcase
O. Crankcase Bolts
115 12 in.l
D (13 1.35 Nm)
F E
60 6 in.l
(6.8 .68 Nm)
G
I
H
I J
60 6 in.lbs. NOTE: If needed, heat
(6.8 .68 Nm) the oil baffle bolts with a
heat gun to remove.
M
192 24 in.lbs
K (21.7 2.7 Nm)
L
Apply Loctite242 to
bolt threads.
O
Apply White Lithium
Grease
3.2
ENGINE
Oil / Water Pump and Timing Cover Exploded View
A. Split Gear
B. Washer
C. Bolt
D. Oil Rotor
E. Oil Pump
F. Mag Gasket Cover
G. Impeller
A H. Washer
B I. Nut
C J. Counterbalance Gear
K. Washer
L. Bolt
D
E
M. Oil Pump Bolts
N. Gear/Stator cover
O. Wire Hold down
3
P. Stator Housing Bolts
F
J
K
L
22 2 ft.lbs. (30 3 Nm)
G
M
H
84 8 in.lbs. (9.5 .90 Nm) I
No Grease on this
Portion of the Gasket!
N 108 12 in.lbs.
(6.8 .68 Nm)
O
Apply corrosion resistant
grease to stator grommet area. P
96 3 in.lbs.
(10.85 0.35 Nm)
Oil Pump Bolt Tighten Sequence
3.3
ENGINE
Starter / Flywheel / Water Pump Exploded View
Apply Polaris
Starter Grease Water Pump Cover
Bolt Tighten Sequence
Apply Polaris 0W-40
oil to seal
Loctite Pipe Sealant
(PN 2871956)
J
A No Grease or Oil
K
84 8 ft.lbs. (9.5 0.9 Nm)
L
Tighten Top Bolt First B 96 12 in.lbs.
(10.85 1.35 Nm)
1
2
C
D
E 108 12 ft.lbs.
(12 1.35 Nm) O
F N M
65 7 ft.lbs.
(88 9.5 Nm)
I
A. Bolts
B. Starter
C. Washer
D. Nut H
E. Positive Cable
F. Negative Cable
G. Gasket
H. Clamp
I. Bolts 96 12 in.lbs.
J. Gasket (10.85 1.35 Nm) Stator Cover Bolt
K. Water Pump Cover Tighten Sequence
L. Bolts
M. Crank Nut/Washer
N. Flywheel
O. Bendix
3.4
ENGINE
Oil System / Level Assembly Exploded View
A. Clamp
B. Oil Fill Tube
C. Dipstick C
D. O-ring
E. Hex Plug 50 5 in.lbs. (5.64 A B
F. Oil Filter Nipple 0.56 Nm)
G. Oil Filter
H. Dowel
I. Galley Plug 22 2 ft.lbs.
J. Nut/washer (30 3 Nm) D
K. Spring
I K 3
H
J
18 2 ft.lbs.
(24.4 2.71 Nm)
E
35 4 ft.lbs.
F (47.5 5.4 Nm)
G
50 5 in. lbs.
(5.65 0.56 Nm)
3.5
ENGINE
Cylinder / Cylinder Head Exploded View
Initial: 35 4 ft. lbs (47.5 5.5
Lubricate threads & between Nm) in sequence. Finalize
washers and underside of bolt sequence by tightening an
heads with engine oil. Torque in 1 additional 90 (1/4 turn)
sequence provided. (Apply each
Bolt Threads)
Apply Moly Lube grease to valve
tips. A
Gasket free of oil. Verify tabs 22 2 ft.lbs.
are visible. (30 3 Nm)B
F
Do Not install expansion plug
more than 1.5 mm inward.
E
1.5 mm
G
4
Side View 4
A. Head Bolts
B. Rocker Arms H
C. Head Assembly
D. Gasket I
E.
F.
Pushrods
Bushing
5 J Circlip UP
for Install
G. Expansion Plug
H. Cylinder
I. Piston Assembly 3
J. Circlip K
K. Gasket
L. Hydraulic Lifter L
6
3.6
ENGINE
Engine Sensors & Misc. Exploded View
A
84 4 in.lbs.
(9.5 0.9 Nm) B
C
A. Screws
20 5 in.lbs.
B.
C.
D.
Rocker Cover
Breather
O-ring Seal
(2.5 0.55 Nm) E
D 3
E. Breather Bolts 18 2 ft.lbs.
F. Spark Plugs (24.5 2.7 Nm)
F
G. Carburetor Boot
H. Bolts (Apply Dielectric Grease
I. Boot Clamp to threads of Spark Plug)
J. Throttle Body
K. Crank Position Sensor
L. Thermistor 18 2 ft.lbs.
G
M. O-ring (24.5 2.7 Nm)
N. Thermostat Housing H
O. Bolts
P. Gasket
Q. Exhaust Manifold 20 5 in.lbs.
R. Bolts (2.5 0.55 Nm) I
S. Thermostat
J K
Apply Corrosion
Resistant Grease 84 4 in.lbs.
(9.5 0.9 Nm)
25 3 ft.lbs.
P L (34 0.14 Nm)
Q
M
N O
84 4 in.lbs.
(9.5 0.9 Nm)
18 2 ft.lbs.
R (24.5 2.7 Nm)
3.7
ENGINE
EFI Harness Exploded View
A. Fuel Injector
B. Fuel Rail
C. EFI Harness
A
B
18 2 ft.lbs.
(24.5 2.7 Nm)
3.8
ENGINE
Engine Fastener Torque Patterns
Crankcase Bolt Tighten Sequence
Lubricate threads and between washer and underside of bolt with engine oil.
Torque in sequence to spec provided, allow the gasket to set for 1 minute, then
tighten in sequence 90 (1/4 turn).
35 4 ft.lbs.
(47.5 5.5 Nm) + 90 (1/4 turn)
3.9
ENGINE
Torque Specifications
3.10
ENGINE
700/800 EFI Engine Service Specifications
Camshaft Journal Outer Diameter - Mag 1.654" 0.00039" (42 0.010 mm)
Camshaft Journal Outer Diameter - Center 1.634" 0.00039" (41.50 0.010 mm)
Camshaft Journal Outer Diameter - PTO 1.614" 0.00039" (41 0.010 mm) 3
Camshaft Camshaft Journal Bore Inner Diameter - Mag 1.656" 0.00039" (42.07 0.010 mm)
Camshaft Journal Bore Inner Diameter - Center 1.637" 0.00039" (41.58 0.010 mm)
Camshaft Journal Bore Inner Diameter - PTO 1.617" 0.00039" (41.07 0.010 mm)
Valve Valve Stem Diameter - Exhaust 0.2351" 0.00039" (5.972 0.01 mm)
Valve Stem Oil Clearance - Intake 0.00228" 0.00098" (0.058 0.025 mm)
Valve Stem Overall Length - Intake 4.51" 0.01476" (114.5550 0.375 mm)
Valve Stem Overall Length - Exhaust 4.5453" .01496" (115.45 0.38 mm)
3.11
ENGINE
Table 3-2: Engine Specifications
MAIN COMPONENTS: CYLINDER/PISTON/
EH068OLE EH076OLE
CONNECTING ROD
Cylinder - Surface warp limit
0.004" (0.10 mm) 0.004" (0.10 mm)
(mating with cylinder head)
Cylinder Bore - Standard 3.1495" (80 mm) 3.1495" (80 mm)
Cylinder Cylinder Taper Limit 0.00031" (0.008 mm) 0.00031" (0.008 mm)
Cylinder Out of Round Limit 0.00030" (0.0075 mm) 0.00030" (0.0075 mm)
.0015" .00059" .0015" .00059"
Cylinder to Piston Clearance
(.040 .015mm) (.040 .015mm)
Lifter Outer Diameter 0.84245" 0.00025" 0.84245" 0.00025"
Standard (21.39 8 0.00635 mm) (21.39 8 0.00635 mm)
Lifter
0.8438" 0.00062" 0.8438" 0.00062"
Lifter Block Bore
(21.4322 0.0157 mm) (21.4322 0.0157 mm)
3.1477" .000121" 3.14803" + .00028"
Piston - Standard
(79.954 .003mm) (79.960 + .007 mm)
Piston
Piston Standard Inner 0.78789" .00009" 0.70902" .00012"
Diameter of Piston Pin Bore (20.0125 0.003 mm) (18.009 0.003 mm)
0.7874" - 0.7872" 0.70866" - 0.70846"
Piston Pin Outer Diameter
(20 - 19.995 mm) (18 - 17.995 mm)
Piston Pin - Standard 0.00059" 0.0002" 0.00047" 0.00024"
Piston Pin
Clearance - Piston Pin to Pin (0.015 0.005 mm) (0.012 0.006 mm)
Piston pin must be a push fit Piston pin must be a push fit
Piston Pin - Degree of Fit
(by hand) at 68 F (20 C) (by hand) at 68 F (20 C)
3.12
ENGINE
Table 3-3: Engine Specifications
MAIN COMPONENTS: PISTON/ CONNECTING ROD EH068OLE EH076OLE
0.0059 0.138" 0.0059 0.138"
Top Ring - Standard
(0.15 0.35mm) (0.15 0.35mm)
Top Ring - Limit > 15% Leakdown > 15% Leakdown
0.0098 0.197" 0.0098 0.197"
Installed Second Ring - Standard
(0.25 0.50mm) (0.25 0.50mm)
Gap
Second Ring - Limit > 15% Leakdown > 15% Leakdown
Piston Ring
Oil Ring - Standard
0.0196 0.00984"
(0.50 0.25mm)
0.0196 0.00984"
(0.50 0.25mm) 3
Oil Ring - Limit > 15% Leakdown > 15% Leakdown
0.0024" 0.0008" 0.0024" 0.0008"
Top Ring - Standard
(0.060 0.020 mm) (0.060 0.020 mm)
Ring to Top Ring - Limit > 15% Leakdown > 15% Leakdown
Groove
Clearance 0.0028" 0.0008" 0.0028" 0.0008"
Second Ring - Standard
(0.070 0.020 mm) (0.070 0.020 mm)
Second Ring - Limit > 15% Leakdown > 15% Leakdown
0.789" 0.78841" 0.7096" 0.70846"
Connecting Rod Small End I.D.
(20.030 20.015 mm) (18 17.995 mm)
Connecting Rod Small End 0.0098" 0.00039"
Same
Connecting Radial Clearance (0.025 0.010mm)
Rod Connecting Rod Big End 0.01181" 0.00591"
Same
Side Clearance (0.030 0.015mm)
Connecting Rod Big End 0.0015" 0.00006"
Same
Radial Clearance (0.0038 0.0015mm)
Crankshaft Crankshaft Runout Limit 0.00236" (0.060mm) Same
Special Tools
3.13
ENGINE
GENERAL ENGINE SERVICE Cooling System Specifications
Piston Identification
Four stroke engine rings have a rectangular profile. See
PISTON RING INSTALLED GAP for ring installation. Use
the information below to identify pistons and rings. Thermostat Water Pump
Table 3-1:
ENGINE MODEL PISTON DIAMETER
Cylinder Head Cylinder
EH068OLE
80 mm
EH076OLE
3.14
ENGINE
Cooling System Pressure Test Four Stroke - Coolant Air Bleeding
Procedure
Pump Hose By
WARNING Hand to Help
Purge System
3.15
ENGINE
Engine Removal (Typical) 9. Relieve the fuel pressure in the fuel rail (refer to Chapter 4,
FUEL INJECTION") for proper procedure. Carefully
remove the fuel rail (B) and injectors.
WARNING
B C
Always wear safety glasses and proper shop
clothing when performing the procedures in this
manual. Failing to do so may lead to possible injury
or death.
3.16
ENGINE
14. Refer to PVT System Chapter 6 to remove outer clutch 19. Remove all engine mount nuts and / or engine mount plates.
cover, drive belt, drive clutch, driven clutch, and inner Remove the frame brace (G) from the front left side of the
cover (F). frame.
F G
15. When removing starter cables, note and mark ground cable
and positive (+) cable mounting angle and locations. 20. Remove the engine from the left side of the frame.
Remove cables.
16. Remove transmission linkage rod from gear selector and
secure out of the way.
17. Disconnect coolant temperature sensor wire located on the
cylinder.
18. Remove engine to chassis ground cable.
3.17
ENGINE
Engine Installation Notes Engine Break-In Period
After the engine is installed in the frame, review this checklist The break-in period for a Polaris ATV engine is defined as the
and perform all steps that apply: first ten hours of operation, or the time it takes to use two full
tanks of gasoline. No single action on your part is as important
General Items as a proper break-in period. Careful treatment of a new engine
will result in more efficient performance and longer life for the
1. Install previously removed components using new gaskets, engine. Perform the following procedures carefully.
seals, and fasteners where applicable.
2. Perform regular checks on fluid levels, controls, and all
CAUTION
important areas on the vehicle as outlined in the daily pre-
ride inspection checklist (refer to Chapter 2 or the Owner's
Manual). Use only Polaris Premium 0-40W All Season
synthetic oil or equivalent.
PVT System Never substitute or mix oil brands. Serious engine
damage and voiding of warranty can result.
1. Adjust center distance of drive and driven clutch. (Chapter Do not operate at full throttle or high speeds for
6) extended periods during the first three hours of use.
2. Adjust clutch offset, alignment, and belt deflection. Excessive heat can build up and cause damage to
(Chapter 6) close fitted engine parts.
3. Clean clutch sheaves thoroughly and inspect inlet and
outlet ducts for proper routing and sealing. (Chapter 6) 1. Fill fuel tank with unleaded or leaded fuel which has a
minimum pump octane number of 87= (R+ M)/2.
Transmission 2. Check oil reservoir level indicated on dipstick. Add oil if
necessary (Refer to Chapter 2, Engine Oil Level ).
1. Inspect transmission operation and adjust linkage if
necessary. Refer to Chapter 2 and Chapter 8. 3. Drive slowly at first to gradually bring engine up to
operating temperature.
Exhaust 4. Vary throttle positions. Do not operate at sustained idle or
sustained high speed.
1. Replace exhaust gaskets. Seal connections with high temp
5. Perform regular checks on fluid levels, controls and all
silicone sealant.
important bolt torques. Pull only light loads during initial
2. Check to be sure all springs are in good condition.
break in.
Bleed Cooling System 6. Pull only light loads during initial break-in.
7. Change break in oil and filter at 20 hours or 200 miles.
NOTE: This cooling system contains vent lines to
help purge trapped air during filling. Bleeding
generally should not be necessary. Cylinder Hone Selection And Honing
Procedure
1. Remove radiator cap and slowly add coolant to the bottom
of filler neck.
2. Fill coolant reservoir tank to full mark.
CAUTION
3. Install radiator cap and gently squeeze coolant hoses to
A hone which will straighten as well as remove
force any trapped air out of system.
material from the cylinder is very important. Using a
4. Again, remove radiator cap and slowly add coolant to the common spring loaded glaze breaker for honing is
bottom of fill neck if needed. not advised for nicasil cylinders.
5. Start engine and observe coolant level in the radiator. Polaris recommends using a rigid hone or arbor
Allow air to purge and top off as necessary. Reinstall honing machine. Cylinders may be wet or dry
radiator cap and bring engine to operating temperature. honed depending upon the hone manufacturer's
After engine is cool, check level in reservoir tank and add recommendations.
coolant if necessary. Wet honing removes more material faster and
NOTE: Should the reservoir tank become empty, it leaves a more distinct pattern in the bore.
will be necessary to refill at the radiator and repeat
the bleeding procedure. Cylinders may be wet or dry honed depending upon the hone
manufacturers recommendations. Wet honing removes more
material faster and leaves a more distinct pattern in the bore.
3.18
ENGINE
Honing To Deglaze
A finished cylinder should have a cross-hatch pattern to ensure
piston ring seating and to aid in the retention of the fuel/oil
mixture during initial break in. Hone cylinder according to hone
manufacturer's instructions, or these guidelines:
Honing should be done with a diamond hone. Cylinder
could be damaged if the hone is not hard enough to
scratch the nicasil lining.
Use a motor speed of approximately 300-500 RPM, run
the hone in and out of the cylinder rapidly until cutting
tension decreases. Remember to keep the hone drive
shaft centered (or cylinder centered on arbor) and to
bring the stones approximately 1/2, (1.3 cm) above and 3
below the bore at the end of each stroke.
Release the hone at regular intervals and inspect the
bore to determine if it has been sufficiently de-glazed,
and to check for correct cross-hatch. NOTE: Do not
allow cylinder to heat up during honing.
After honing has been completed, inspect cylinder for
thinning or peeling.
If cylinder wear or damage is excessive, it will be necessary to
replace the cylinder. The cylinders are lined with a nicasil
coating and are not repairable. Hone only enough to de-glaze
the outer layer of the cylinder bore.
3.19
ENGINE
Oil Flow Chart
This chart describes the flow of oil through the 700/800 engine. Beginning in the crankcase sump, the oil is drawn through an oil
galley to the feed side of the oil pump. The oil is then pumped through the oil filter. If the oil filter is obstructed, a bypass valve
contained in the filter allows oil to bypass the filter element. At this point, the oil is supplied to the main oil galley through a crankcase
passage. Oil is then diverted three ways from the main oil galley, with the first path entering the camshaft bores, onto the rear balance
shaft journal and then draining back into the crankcase sump. The second oil path from the main oil galley feeds the lifter bores and
then drains back to the crankcase sump. The third oil path flows through a crankcase galley to the MAG side crankshaft journal and
also to the front balance shaft journal and onto the crankcase sump. The oil pressure switch is fed off the main oil galley.
3.20
ENGINE
ENGINE DISASSEMBLY AND INSPECTION
Cylinder Head Assembly Exploded View
Rocker Arms
:Push Rods
Spring Retainers
3
Springs
Valve Seals
Cylinder Head
Hydraulic Lifters
Valves
3.21
ENGINE
Rocker Arms 5. If the push rod (A) is visibly bent, it should be replaced.
WARNING
3. Check the ends of the push rods (A) for nicks, grooves, B
roughness or excessive wear.
4. The push rods (A) can be visually checked for straightness
while they are installed in the engine by rotating them with
C
the valve closed. Push rods can also be checked with a dial
indicator or rolled across a flat surface to check for
straightness.
D
3.22
ENGINE
Cylinder Head Inspection Valve Seal/Spring Service
(On Engine)
Thoroughly clean cylinder head surface to remove all traces of
gasket material and carbon. NOTE: The following procedure is only for servicing
the top end of the valve train when replacing valve
springs or replacing valve seals.
CAUTION
In some cases the valve train can be serviced while the cylinder
Use care not to damage sealing surface. head is still on the engine. Keep all parts in order with respect
to their location in the cylinder head.
Cylinder Head Warp
1. Lay a straight edge (A) across the surface of the cylinder
WARNING 3
head (B) at several different points and measure warp by
inserting a feeler gauge between the straight edge and the Wear eye protection or a face shield during cylinder
cylinder head surface. If warp exceeds the service limit, head disassembly and reassembly.
replace the cylinder head.
1. Having already removed the valve cover, rocker arms and
pushrods, align the cylinder to be worked on at top dead
A center (TDC). Install the Valve Pressure Hose (PU-
45652) into the spark plug hole. Hook the hose to an air
compressor and supply 50 to 100 psi to the hose. This will
seat the valves during valve spring removal. Do not
remove air from the hose at anytime until reassembly is
completed.
2. Using the Valve Spring Compressor (PU-45257),
compress the valve spring and remove the valve keepers.
B NOTE: A small parts magnet (A) can aid in the removal
of the retainers (B).
Measure at different
points on the surface.
B
= In. / mm.
A
Cylinder Head Warp Limit:
.004" (.1016 mm) max
PU-45257
3.23
ENGINE
Cylinder Head Disassembly 3. Remove valve guide seals.
IMPORTANT: It is recommended to replace seals
1. Carefully remove the cylinder components. Place the whenever the cylinder head is disassembled.
hydraulic lifters (C), pushrods (D), and rocker arms (E) in Hardened, cracked or worn valve seals will cause
a safe, clean area. excessive oil consumption and carbon buildup.
4. Mark the valves with a white pen. Remove the valves from
D the cylinder head. This will ensure that the valves are
properly placed during engine reassembly.
C
Mark the Valves
Valve Spring
Free Length
= In. / mm.
3.24
ENGINE
Valve Inspection measurements total). Compare to specifications.
3
= In. / mm.
A C
= In. / mm.
3.25
ENGINE
Combustion Chamber NOTE: Valve seat width and point of contact on the
valve face is very important for proper sealing. The
1. Clean all accumulated carbon deposits from combustion valve must contact the valve seat over the entire
chamber and valve seat area with carbon cleaner and a soft circumference of the seat, and the seat must be the
plastic scraper. proper width all the way around. If the seat is
IMPORTANT: Do not use a wire brush, metal scraper, uneven, compression leakage will result. If the seat
or abrasive cleaners to clean the bottom of the
cylinder head. Extensive damage to the cylinder head is too wide, seat pressure is reduced, causing
may result. Wear safety glasses during cleaning. carbon accumulation and possible compression
loss. If the seat is too narrow, heat transfer from
Combustion Area valve to seat is reduced. The valve may overheat
and warp, resulting in burnt valves.
WARNING
3.26
ENGINE
4. Inspect the cut area of the seat: NOTE: When using an interference angle, the seat
contact point on the valve will be very narrow, and is
* If the contact area is less than 75% of the circumference of the a normal condition. Look for an even and
seat, rotate the pilot 180 and make another light cut. continuous contact point all the way around the
* If the cutter now contacts the uncut portion of the seat, check valve face. (B)
the pilot. Look for burrs, nicks, or runout. If the pilot is bent it
must be replaced.
* If the contact area of the cutter is in the same place, the valve
guide is distorted from improper installation B
* If the contact area of the initial cut is greater than 75%,
A
continue to cut the seat until all pits are removed and a new seat
surface is evident. NOTE: Remove only the amount of material
necessary to repair the seat surface.
3
5. To check the contact area of the seat on the valve face, apply Proper Seat Contact
On Valve Face
a thin coating of Prussian Blue paste to the valve seat. If
using an interference angle (46) apply black permanent
marker to the entire valve face (A).
Seat 45 Top 30
Bottom 60
6. Insert valve into guide and tap valve lightly into place a few
times.
7. Remove valve and check where the Prussian Blue
indicates seat contact on the valve face. The valve seat
should contact the middle of the valve face or slightly Seat Width
above, and must be the proper width.
* If the indicated seat contact is at the top edge of the valve face
and contacts the margin area (B) it is too high on the valve face.
Use the 30 cutter to lower the valve seat.
* If too low, use the 60 cutter to raise the seat. When contact
area is centered on the valve face, measure seat width.
* If the seat is too wide or uneven, use both top and bottom
cutters to narrow the seat.
= In. / mm.
* If the seat is too narrow, widen using the 45 cutter and re-
check contact point on the valve face and seat width after each
cut. Valve Seat Width:
Intake Std: .028" (.7 mm)
Limit: .055" (1.4 mm)
Exhaust Std: .039I (1.0 mm)
Limit: .071" (1.8 mm)
8. Clean all filings from the area with hot soapy water, rinse,
and dry with compressed air.
3.27
ENGINE
9. Lubricate the valve guides with clean engine oil, and apply 4. Valve seals should be installed after the valves are in the
oil or water based lapping compound to the face of the head to avoid valve seal damage. Install new valve seals
valve. on valve guides.
NOTE: Lapping is not required with an interference
angle valve job.
10. Insert the valve into its respective guide and lap using a
lapping tool or a section of fuel line connected to the valve
stem.
11. Rotate the valve rapidly back and forth until the cut sounds
smooth. Lift the valve slightly off of the seat, rotate 1/4
turn, and repeat the lapping process. Do this four to five
times until the valve is fully seated, and repeat process for
the other valve(s).
12. Thoroughly clean cylinder head and valves.
3.28
ENGINE
7. Repeat procedure for remaining valves. When all valves Valve Lifter Removal/Inspection
are installed, tap lightly with soft faced hammer on the end
of the valves to seat the split keepers. 1. Remove the valve lifter's by reaching into the crankcase
and pushing the lifter up through the lifter bore by hand.
NOTE: To prevent damage to the valve seals, do not
2. Thoroughly clean the lifters in cleaning solvent and wipe
compress the valve spring more than necessary to
them with a clean lint-free cloth.
install the keepers.
3. Mark the lifters with a white pen if using the lifters for
Valve Sealing Test reassembly. This will ensure that the lifters are properly
placed during engine reassembly.
1. Clean and dry the combustion chamber area (A).
Mark Hydraulic Lifter
A 3
2. Pour a small amount of clean solvent onto the intake port 4. Check the lifters for wear or scores.
and check for leakage around each intake valve. The valve 5. Check the bottom end of lifter to make sure that it has a
seats should hold fluid with no seepage. slight convex.
3. Repeat for exhaust valves by pouring fluid into exhaust 6. If the bottom surface has worn flat, it may be used with the
port. original camshaft only.
3.29
ENGINE
Piston Removal *By hand: Placing both thumbs as shown, spread the ring open
and push up on the opposite side. Do not scratch the ring lands.
1. Remove circlip (A). Mark the piston with a white pen to
ensure proper orientation (if reused) during assembly.
NOTE: If the pistons are to be reused, reassemble 4. Repeat procedure for second ring.
the pistons in the same cylinder and direction from 5. Remove the oil control ring.
which they were removed.
The oil control ring is a three piece design consisting of a top and
NOTE: New pistons are non-directional and can be bottom steel rail and a center expander section. The top rail has
a locating tab on the end which fits into a notch (B) in the upper
placed in either cylinder. oil ring land of the piston.
2. Remove piston circlip and push piston pin out of piston. If To Remove:
necessary, heat the crown of the piston slightly with a
propane torch. CAUTION: Do not apply heat to the piston A) Remove the top rail first followed by the bottom rail.
rings. The ring may lose radial tension. B) Remove the expander.
3. Remove top compression ring:
B
*Using a piston ring pliers: Carefully expand ring and lift it off Compression
the piston. CAUTION: Do not expand the ring more than the Rings
amount necessary to remove it from the piston, or the ring may
break.
Oil Ring
3.30
ENGINE
Cylinder Inspection 3. Inspect cylinder for wear, scratches, or damage.
= In. / mm.
1/2 Up From Bottom
Cylinder Warp: .004" (0.1 mm) Max.
= In. / mm.
3.31
ENGINE
Piston-To-Cylinder Clearance 2. Measure piston pin O.D. Replace piston and/or piston pin
if out of tolerance.
Measure piston outside diameter at a point 5 mm up from the
bottom of the piston at a right angle to the direction of the piston
pin.
Subtract this measurement from the maximum cylinder
measurement obtained in Step 5.
5 mm
Piston Pin
Piston O.D.:
See 700/800 EFI Engine Service
Specifications on page 3.11
Piston/rod Inspection
1. Measure piston pin bore.
3.32
ENGINE
4. Measure piston ring to groove clearance by placing the ring thoroughly with hot soapy water, rinsed, and dried
in the ring land and measuring with a thickness gauge. completely. Wipe cylinder bore with oil immediately
Replace piston and rings if ring-to-groove clearance to remove residue and prevent rust.
exceeds service limits.
Starter Drive/Bendix Removal Inspection
See 700/800 EFI Engine Service Specifications on page 3.11
1. Remove stator housing bolts and remove housing.
2. Remove the flywheel nut and washer. Install Flywheel
Piston
Puller (PN 2871043) and remove flywheel.
NOTE: Do not thread the puller bolts into the
Ring flywheel more than 1/4, or stator coils may be
damaged. 3
3. Remove starter bendix assembly (A). Note the thrust
washers located on both sides of the bendix.
Feeler Gauge
B
Piston Ring Installed Gap
1. Place each piston ring (A) inside cylinder (B) using piston
to push ring squarely into place as shown. (See next page)
C
B
25-50 mm
3.33
ENGINE
6. Inspect gear teeth on starter drive (B). Replace starter drive 3. Install Flywheel Puller (PN 2871043) and remove
if gear teeth are cracked, worn, or broken. flywheel (A). CAUTION: Do not thread the puller bolts
7. Inspect the bendix bushing (C) in the mag cover for wear. into the flywheel more than 1/4, or stator coils may be
Replace as needed. damaged.
2871043 A
4. Use caution when removing the wire holddown (B), trigger
coil (C), and the stator assembly (D). Do not tap or bump
Flywheel / Stator Removal / Inspection the gear /stator housing cover or the stator. This could
cause the seal around the gear/stator housing cover and the
1. Remove stator housing bolts and remove housing.
crankcase to break, causing a leak.
C
B
E D
Remove Stator
Cover
5. Remove the bendix (E) if necessary.
2. Remove flywheel nut and washer.
3.34
ENGINE
Engine Crankcase Disassembly / Inspection 4. Install Flywheel Puller (PN 2871043) and remove flywheel
(F). CAUTION: Do not thread the puller bolts into the
1. Remove the stator cover (A) and water pump cover (B). flywheel more than 1/4, or stator coils may be damaged.
F
A 5. Remove the starter bendix (G), wire holddown plate (H),
and the woodruff key (I) from the crankshaft. The stator
2. Remove the nylok nut (C), washer (D), and water pump does not have to be removed at this point.
impeller (E). Remove part of the water pump seal behind
the impeller.
I
H
D
C 6. Remove the gear/stator housing bolts and remove the gear/
stator housing cover (J) and gasket from the crankcase. Be
sure to catch the excess oil from the crankcase.
3. Remove flywheel nut and washer.
3.35
ENGINE
7. Note the positions of the gears in the photo. 10. Inspect the cam gear teeth and check to make sure there is
spring tension offsetting the teeth between the two gears.
If there is no tension, check the springs inside of the cam
Camshaft Gear gear assembly.
3 Loaded Springs
* Place the cam gear on a flat surface with the timing mark side
K Water Pump Gear facing up.
Timing Marks * While holding both gears together, lightly work a small
flathead screwdriver between the two gears.
* Remove the top gear. The springs should stay in place.
CAUTION
NOTE: If replacing one of the gears, it is 12. Remove all three springs using one of the tapered pins from
recommended that all of the gears be replaced. A the Tapered Pins (PU-45497-1).
gear kit is available in the parts book.
3.36
ENGINE
13. With a white marking pen, accent the timing mark on the 16. Insert the pointed dowels from the Tapered Pins (PU-
gear that contains the springs. 45497-1) into the cam gear.
To Assemble:
14. Inspect the gear teeth and the three tabs on the gears for
wear. * Hold the spring with one finger.
* Start the pointed end of the tapered pin into the cam gear hole
Inspect Teeth & Tabs and slowly push the dowel through the hole until the end of the
dowel is almost flush with the spring.
* Perform this procedure with all three tapered pins.
* Do not push the pins too far through or the springs will pop
out.
NOTE: Do not remove the tapered pins at this time.
Replace 3 Springs
15. Install the new springs into the grooves of the cam gear.
Install Springs
PU-45497-1
3.37
ENGINE
18. Line up the two gears using the timing marks and the three NOTE: Install the Cam Gear Alignment Tool (PU-
gear tabs that were referenced earlier. Push the gears back 45497-2) into one assembly hole counter clockwise
together, using both hands and hold securely. from the timing mark.
PU--45497-2
19. Once the gears are pressed together, firmly hold the gears
together with one hand. Carefully remove the Tapered Pins
(PU-45497-1) by pulling them out one at a time with the
other hand. NOTE: For ease of installing the Cam Gear
Alignment Tool (PU-45497-2) (R), use a twisting
motion when pushing down on the tool.
21. To remove the balance shaft gear, the flat side of the
camshaft (P) must face the balance shaft gear. To rotate the
camshaft, use the Cam Spanner Wrench (PU-45498) to
rotate the camshaft so the flat side of the camshaft faces the
balance shaft gear.
PU-45498
20. After the tapered pins are removed, be sure the cam gear
assembly is held together tightly. Place the cam gear
assembly on a flat surface. Use the Cam Gear Tooth
Alignment Tool (PU-45497-2) to align the teeth of the cam P
gears, as shown in the picture.
3.38
ENGINE
22. Remove the bolt and nut from the balance shaft gear. Try 25. Install the Flywheel Puller (PN 2871043) and remove the
to remove the balance shaft gear. If the gear does not come crankshaft gear, if needed.
off manually, use the Flywheel Puller (PN 2871043) to
remove the balance shaft gear. 2871043
2871043
26. Rotate the water/oil pump gear (S), so that all four bolts are
23. Inspect the crankshaft gear (Q) for broken or worn teeth. If visible though the gear. Remove the four bolts with a hex
the crankshaft gear does not need to be replaced, it does not wrench. Pull out the pump.
need to be removed. If the crankshaft gear is damaged,
remove the crankshaft gear with the Flywheel Puller (PN
2871043).
S
27. Inspect the oil pump rotors for wear. Mark the rotors with
a white pen to ensure upon reassembly that the correct sides
of the rotors are installed and mesh with the same edges as
24. Install the two puller bolts (R). Tighten the puller bolts up previously installed.
so that the bolts are at equal length.
3.39
ENGINE
28. Use a feeler gauge to measure the clearance between the NOTE: Be sure to place the tapered end of the valve
two rotors. Measure the gap between the two rotor tips as (dowel) in first. If the valve is installed incorrectly,
shown below. The clearance should not exceed 0.006" oil pressure and oil priming problems will occur.
(0.15 mm).
31. Carefully press the gear off the assembly while supporting
the housing assembly.
29. Remove the oil pressure relief. The oil pressure relief
consists of a bolt, washer, spring, and valve (dowel).
Inspect the valve (dowel) for signs of possible obstructions.
CAUTION
Use compressed air to blow out any debris.
Wear appropriate safety gear during this procedure.
Protective gloves, clothing and eyewear are
required.
32. Remove the snap ring from the assembly. Place the housing
in a support and press out the bearing/shaft assembly.
30. Reinstall the valve (dowel chamfered end first). Install the Bearing
spring, washer, and bolt. Torque to specification .
Chamfer
End First
=T
22 2 ft. lbs. (30 3 Nm)
3.40
ENGINE
33. Place the shaft in a press to remove the bearing. 36. Press gear onto shaft while supporting the housing.
Bearing
New Bearing
3.41
ENGINE
NOTE: Only remove the oil baffle if the baffle is 41. Remove and inspect crankshaft main journal bearings for
damaged. When removing the oil baffle bolts, use a abnormal wear. It is recommended to replace the
heat gun to heat the bolts and loosen the Loctite. bearings anytime the engine is disassembled.
This will prevent any possible damage to the bolts or
to the crankcase casting.
39. Remove and clean oil pick up (V) and oil baffle weldment
(W).
V
NOTE: Plain bearing clearances may be checked
using a commercially available plasti-gauge
material.
Camshaft Inspection
40. Remove balance shaft and crankshaft. 1. Thoroughly clean the cam shaft.
2. Visually inspect each cam lobe for wear, chafing or
damage.
3. Measure height of each cam lobe using a micrometer.
Compare to specification.
= In. / mm.
3.42
ENGINE
4. Measure camshaft journal outside diameters (O.D.). ENGINE REASSEMBLY
CRANKCASE REASSEMBLY
CAUTION
B
to help aid proper break-in. 3
NOTE: Before assembly, clean the bolts and bolt
A
holes with Primer N (PN 2870585) to remove any
debris. This will ensure proper sealing when
installing bolts.
= In. / mm.
3.43
ENGINE
NOTE: Always install new balance shaft bearings. 6.Apply Crankcase Sealant (PN 2871557) to the top gearcase
halve.
NOTE: Do not apply sealant to cam relief hole (E).
C
=T
Crankcase Bolt Torque:
22 + 2 ft. lbs. (30 + 3 Nm)
Torque in sequence
Lifters
3.44
ENGINE
9. Lubricate lifters with engine oil and install in the original 12. Orientate the piston rings on the piston before installation
order as removed in disassembly. Apply Lubriplate or into the cylinders. Set the gaps of the rings evenly 120
Moly Lube to the ends of the lifters. apart. (see illustration)
NOTE: Always replace the camshaft and lifters as a
set. 1
Piston Ring
Orientation 2
3
3. Oil Ring
11. Install new cylinder gasket on crankcase. Align gasket on NOTE: To help align the pistons, slide a rod that is
the dowel pins for proper gasket alignment. close to the same diameter as the wrist pin holes to
properly align them in the cylinder.
3.45
ENGINE
14. Position cylinder and piston assemblies onto the connecting 16. Install camshaft thrust plate (G) with new bolts. Torque
rods and push the piston pins through the piston and bolts to specification.
connecting rods.
=T
Thrust Plate Screw Torque:
115 12 in.lbs. (13 1.35 Nm)
18. Apply assembly lube or oil to the rotors on the oil pump
shaft.
3.46
ENGINE
NOTE: The application of lubrication aids in priming NOTE: Occasionally spin the oil pump when
the oil pump during initial engine start up. installing bolts to check for binding of the rotors.
Lubricate Rotors
19. Align the bolt holes and install oil pump assembly into
crankcase. Rotate the rotors in the housing during
=T
installation, as this checks for binding if new rotors are
used. Oil Pump Bolt Torque:
84 8 in.lbs. (9.50 0.90 Nm)
NOTE: For assembly of the gears, the cam gear and
* Torque in Sequence
the crankshaft gear are stamped with This Side
Out." This indicates the side of the gear that faces
outward or away from the case. 21. Apply Loctite 242 (PN 2871949) to the crankshaft.
20. Install oil pump housing bolts (H). The new bolts contain
patch lock, so Loctite is not needed on the new bolts.
Torque bolts to specification and follow the torque
sequence at beginning of the chapter.
3.47
ENGINE
22. Before installing the crankshaft gear (I), heat the crankshaft 25. Install counter balance shaft gear (J) with new key, aligning
gear to 250 F (121C) on a hot plate (J). timing marks with crankshaft gear (I). Install washer and
bolt. Use the Gear Holder (PU-45838). Torque to
specification.
I J
CAUTION
PU-45497-2
3.48
ENGINE
NOTE: Cam Spanner Wrench (PU-45498) is only Before installing the gear/stator housing, replace the seals in the
needed to rotate the camshaft when the entire valve
train is assembled.
Timing Marks
PU-45498
=T 3
Counterbalance Gear and Camshaft
Gear Bolt Torque:
22 2 ft. lbs. (30 3 Nm)
cover. Install a new water pump seal (N) into the gear/stator
housing (O). Use the Water Pump Mechanical Seal Installer
(PA-44995) to properly install the seal to the correct depth in the
27. Reinstall the camshaft gear; so the timing marks are cover.
properly aligned. Install the washer and bolt. Torque to Due to seal design and construction, seals MUST be
specification.
NOTE: Be sure all of the timing marks are properly
aligned. PA-44995
Water Pump Gear O
K
PA
Timing Marks
-4 4
99
N
5
N
M
installed DRY (no lubricant) during assembly. Use of
lubricants (oil, soapy water, etc.) will not allow the seal
to wear-in and seal properly. Do not touch seal
surface or allow seal surface to come in contact with
contaminates during installation. Thoroughly clean
parts, tools and hands before installation.
NOTE: To remove the water pump seal, the gear/
stator housing must be removed. The water pump
seal cannot be removed or installed with the gear/
stator housing attached to the engine. Shaft damage
will occur.
NOTE: Install the water pump seal (N) with the seal
lip facing out (towards the crankcase). Use of a
hydraulic press is recommended for this procedure.
3.49
ENGINE
28. Install a new crankshaft seal (P) into the gear/stator housing 30. Carefully install the tapered end of the Crankshaft Seal
cover (O). Use the Universal Driver Handle (PU-45543) Protection Tool (PA-45658) through the paper side of the
and the Main Seal Installer (PA-45483) to seat the crankshaft seal. (Back to Front) Leave the seal protector
crankshaft seal into place. installed in the crankshaft seal. Check the crankshaft seal
lips to verify they have not been rolled or damaged.
PU-45543
PA-45483
NOTE: Install the crankshaft seal (P) with the seal lip 31. Before installing the gear/stator housing cover, install the
facing out (towards the crankcase). Water Pump Seal Saver (PA-45401) onto the water pump
shaft.
P
PA-45401
PA-54658
3.50
ENGINE
33. Apply Crankcase Sealant (PN 2871557) to the outside 35. Secure the gear/stator housing cover (O) to the crankcase
edges of the crankcase halves (See arrows), where the with the cover bolts. Torque bolts in proper sequence to
crankcases mate. (See photos below.) This helps to prevent specification. Remove seal protectors from the shaft ends
coolant leakage. once secure.
PA-45401
3
O
PA-45658
=T
Gear/Stator Housing Bolt Torque:
96 3 in. lbs. (10.85 0.35 Nm)
*Torque in proper sequence
3.51
ENGINE
37. Install water pump impeller (P). Secure the impeller with 39. Sparingly apply Starter Drive Grease (PN 2871423) to the
the washer and a new nylok nut (Q). Torque the nut to starter drive. Install the starter bendix.
specification. NOTE: There are thrust washers on both sides of
starter drive.
=T
40. Install stator assembly (S) and bolts. Torque bolts to
specification.
Water Pump Impeller Nut Torque:
108 6 in. lbs. (6.8 0.68 Nm) 41. Install the wire hold down bracket (T). Install two new wire
hold down bolts. New bolts contain patch-lock. Torque
38. Install water pump cover (R) with new O-ring seal. Torque bolts to specification, following the proper bolt torque
bolts to specification in proper sequence (See front of this sequence. Coat the stator wire grommet (U) with Nyogel
chapter). Grease (PN 2871329).
NOTE: Verify stator wires are routed properly under
the wire hold down bracket.
Install the O-ring dry, no lubricants
Replace 2 bolts with new bolts.
96 3 in. lbs.
(10.85 1.35 Nm) T
S
U
=T
Water Pump Housing Bolt Torque: =T
96 3 in. lbs. (10.85 0.35 Nm)
*Torque in proper sequence Stator Assembly Bolt Torque:
96 3 in.lbs. (10.85 0.35 Nm)
3.52
ENGINE
42. Install the flywheel, washer, nut, and key. Torque flywheel minutes. Install the filter onto the engine.
nut to specification.
45. Remove primer plug from the engine. Install Oil System
Priming Adapter (PU-45778) into the oil plug hole. Push
=T 3-5 oz. (approx.) of Polaris 0W-40 into the adapter or until
resistance is felt. Remove the adapter. Apply sealant to the
Flywheel Nut Torque plug threads. Install the plug and torque to specification.
65 7 ft.lbs. (88 9.50 Nm)
PU-45778
43. Install stator housing with new o-rings. Torque the bolts to
specification and follow proper bolt torque sequence at the
beginning of this chapter.
96 3 in.lbs.
(10.85 0.35 Nm)
=T
Primer Plug Torque
=T 18 2 ft.lbs. (24.4 2.71 Nm)
44. After the engine is completely assembled and ready for After any reassembly or rebuild, the engine must be
installation, the engine must be properly primed with primed using the Oil Priming Adapter (PU-45778)
Polaris 0W-40 Synthetic Oil (PN 2871281). Fill the oil and a 3/4-full oil filter before initial start-up. Follow
filter three-quarters full with Polaris 0W-40 Synthetic Oil the steps in this section to properly prime the engine
(PN 2871281). Let the oil soak into the filter for 8-10 and aid proper engine break in. Failure to perform
this procedure may cause internal engine damage
on initial start-up.
3.53
ENGINE
Flywheel / Stator Installation 5. Inspect the mating surface around the gear/stator housing
cover and the crankcase for oil seepage. If there is seepage
NOTE: Before assembly, clean the bolts and bolt between the mating surfaces, then the gear/stator housing
holes with Primer N (PN 2870585) to remove any cover must be resealed. Clean the gearcase surfaces and
debris. This will ensure proper sealing when reseal with a new gasket. Refer to the Lower Engine
installing bolts. Disassembly section and the Lower Engine Assembly
section for details. lnspect the areas pointed out in the
1. Carefully install the stator and trigger coil to the gear/stator illustration for possible oil seepage.
housing cover. Do not tap on the stator or the gear
stator housing cover. This may cause a leak in between
the gear/stator housing cover and the crankcase.
2. Properly place the stator wires under the wire holddown
and install the bolts. Inspect the bolts, if new bolts are
needed, replace them with new bolts. New bolts contain
patch lock, so Loctite is not needed. Torque bolts to
specification.
96 3 in.lbs.
(1.85 0.35 Nm)
=T
Flywheel Nut Torque:
65 7 ft.lbs. (88 9.5 Nm)
=T
Stator Housing Bolt Torque:
96 3 in.lbs. (1.85 0.35 Nm)
*Torque in Sequence
3.54
ENGINE
Cylinder Head Reassembly 4. Lubricate push rods (D) and install into lifters.
A
3
B E
C
6. Verify pushrods are engaged in lifters.
7. Install rockers. Be sure that tab of fulcrum (F) is seated in
head stand-off. Torque bolts to specification.
=T
Cylinder Head Bolt Torque:
Initial setting: 35 4 ft. lbs. (47.5 5.5 Nm)
Allow to set for 1 minute, then turn
additional 90 (1/4 turn)
*Torque Bolts In Sequence
=T
Rocker Arm Bolt Torque
22 + 2 ft. lbs. (30 3 Nm)
3.55
ENGINE
8. Install breather reed (G) into rocker cover (H). Lightly 11. Install thermostat (J), new O-ring, and thermostat housing.
apply black RTV sealant to the outer edges of the breather Torque to specification.
reed. The reed has a tab and will assemble one-way only.
Torque the breather bolts to specification.
=T 84 8 in.lbs.
(9.5 0.9 Nm)
Breather Bolt Toque:
20 5 in. lbs. (2.5 0.55 Nm)
NOTE: When applying RTV, do not get any RTV 25 3 ft.lbs. (34 4 Nm)
inside the reed assembly.
9. Place a new seal (I) into the bottom of the cover. Be sure
the seal is seated into the cover properly.
IMPORTANT: Before assembly, clean the bolts and
bolt holes with Primer N (PN 2870585) to remove any
debris. This will ensure proper sealing when
installing bolts. =T
20 5 in.lbs. Thermostat Housing Bolt Torque:
(2.5 .55 Nm)
84 8 in. lbs. (9.5 0.9 Nm)
G I
=T
3.56
ENGINE
TROUBLESHOOTING Engine Idles But Will Not Accelerate
Spark plug fouled/weak spark
Engine
Broken throttle cable
Spark Plug Fouling
Obstruction in air intake
Spark plug cap loose or faulty
Air box removed (reinstall all intake components)
Incorrect spark plug heat range or gap
Incorrect or restricted carburetor jetting
PVT system calibrated incorrectly/ components worn or
mis-adjusted ETC switch limiting speed
Fuel quality poor (old) or octane too high Reverse speed limiter limiting speed
3
Low compression Incorrect ignition timing
Restricted exhaust Restricted exhaust system
Weak ignition (loose coil ground, faulty coil, stator, or Cam worn excessively
ETC switch)
Engine Has Low Power
ETC switch mis-adjusted
Spark plug fouled
Restricted air filter (main or pre-cleaner) or breather
system Cylinder, piston, ring, or valve wear or damage (check
compression)
Improperly assembled air intake system
PVT not operating properly
Restricted engine breather system
Restricted exhaust muffler
Oil contaminated with fuel
Cam worn excessively
Engine Turns Over But Fails To Start
Piston Failure - Scoring
No fuel
Lack of lubrication
Dirt in fuel line or filter
Dirt entering engine through cracks in air filter or ducts
Fuel will not pass through fuel valve
Engine oil dirty or contaminated
Fuel pump inoperative/restricted
Tank vent plugged or pinched Excessive Smoke and Carbon Buildup
Engine flooded Excessive piston-to-cylinder clearance
Low compression (high cylinder leakage) Wet sumping (Oil Level Too Full)
No spark (Spark plug fouled) ignition component Worn rings, piston, or cylinder
failure
Worn valve guides or seals
Engine Does Not Turn Over Restricted breather
Dead battery Air filter dirty or contaminated
Starter motor does not turn
Piston Failure - Scoring
Engine seized, rusted, or mechanical failure
Lack of lubrication
Engine Runs But Will Not Idle Dirt entering engine through cracks in air filter or ducts
Restricted carburetor pilot system Engine oil dirty or contaminated
Low compression
Crankcase breather restricted
3.57
ENGINE
Excessive Smoke and Carbon Buildup Cooling System
Excessive piston-to-cylinder clearance Overheating
Wet sumping due to over-full crankcase Low coolant level
Worn rings, piston, or cylinder Air in cooling system
Worn valve guides or seals Wrong type/mix of coolant
Restricted breather Faulty pressure cap or system leaks
Air filter dirty or contaminated Restricted system (mud or debris in radiator fins
causing restriction to air flow, passages blocked in
Low Compression radiator, lines, pump, or water jacket, accident damage)
Cylinder head gasket leak Lean mixture (restricted jets, vents, fuel pump or fuel
valve)
No valve clearance ( cam wear )
Fuel pump output weak
Cylinder or piston worn
Electrical malfunction
Piston rings worn, leaking, broken, or sticking
Water pump failure/ Loose impeller
Bent valve or stuck valve
Thermistor failure
Valve spring broken or weak
Cooling fan inoperative or turning too slowly (perform
Valve not seating properly (bent or carbon accumulated current draw test)
on sealing surface)
Ignition timing mis-adjusted
Rocker arm sticking
Low oil level
Backfiring
Spark plug incorrect heat range
ETC or speed limiter system malfunction Faulty hot light circuit
Fouled spark plug or incorrect plug or plug gap Thermostat stuck closed or not opening completely
Exhaust system air leaks
Temperature Too Low
Exhaust system air leaks
Thermostat stuck open
Ignition system faulty: Spark plug cap cracked/broken,
Ignition coil faulty, Ignition or kill switch circuit faulty, Leak at Water Pump Weep Hole
Ignition poor connections in ignition system
Faulty water pump mechanical seal (coolant leak)
n timing incorrect, Sheared flywheel key
Faulty pump shaft oil seal (oil leak)
Valve sticking
3.58
ENGINE
800 EFI EXHAUST SYSTEM (DELUXE) 3. If the canisters are stained from oils or other fluids, use fine
steel wool with HPC Liquid Buff Cleaner and Polish to
Dual Exhaust Layout remove the stain.
4. After removing the stains, polish using Liquid Buff and
The dual exhaust canisters on select Polaris 800 EFIs are silver a soft cloth.
ceramic coated. To maintain a beautiful finish and prevent
corrosion, periodic maintenance is required. DO NOT use 5. Repeat this procedure as often as desired to maintain the
caustic chemicals to clean, as they may damage the finish. canister's finish.
1. Wash any accumulated mud or debris from the canisters NOTE: Silencer removal requires replacement of the
with a soft brush and soapy water. silencer grommets, item H, as they become
2. Use a cleaner, such as HPC HiPerWash to clean away any damaged during removal.
remaining grime, salts or oils.
3
A. Mounting Hardware
B. Clean Out Plug
C. Exhaust Seal/Clamp
D. Dual Exhaust Pipe
E. Exhaust Shields
F. Gasket
G. Exhaust Silencers A.
H. Silencer Grommets
G
C
G E
B
D
3.59
ENGINE
NOTES
3.60
FUEL INJECTION
CHAPTER 4
FUEL INJECTION
GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2
SERVICE NOTES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3
EFI SYSTEM EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
EFI SYSTEM COMPONENT LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5
FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6
FUEL LINES - QUICK CONNECT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6
ELECTRONIC FUEL INJECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.7
PRINCIPAL COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.7
EFI OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.7
INITIAL PRIMING / STARTING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.7
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8
4
ECU SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8
ECU REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.8
FUEL PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.9
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.9
FUEL PUMP TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.9
FUEL PUMP / TANK ASSEMBLY REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.10
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR REPLACEMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL FILTERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
GENERAL INFORMATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL FILTER SERVICE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL FILTER REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12
FUEL INJECTORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13
FUEL INJECTOR SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13
FUEL INJECTOR REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (CPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (CPS) REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14
TEMPERATURE / BAROMETRIC AIR PRESSURE SENSOR (T-BAP). . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
TEMPERATURE AND BAROMETRIC AIR PRESSURE SENSOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
TEMPERATURE AND BAROMETRIC AIR PRESSURE SENSOR REPLACEMENT . . 4.15
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (TPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR REPLACEMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.16
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR INITIALIZATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.16
ENGINE TEMPERATURE SENSOR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
ENGINE TEMPERATURE SENSOR TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
ENGINE TEMPERATURE SENSOR REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
TROUBLESHOOTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.19
DIAGNOSTICS USING BLINK CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.19
EFI TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.20
4.1
FUEL INJECTION
GENERAL INFORMATION
WARNING
Polaris EFI Diagnostic This tester allows the use of a digital multi-meter to test TPS
function as well perform initialization procedures.
PU-47063 Software (Digital
Wrench) Throttle Body Adjustment Screwdriver - PU-47315
Fuel Pressure This tool has a special D shaped end for adjusting the throttle
PU-43506 stop screw during a TPS initialization procedure.
Test Kit
Throttle Position Sensor
2201519
Tester
Throttle Body
PU-47315 Adjustment Screwdriver
(small D shape)
4.2
FUEL INJECTION
Service Notes
For more convenient and accurate testing of EFI components, it is recommended dealers utilize the Polaris Diagnostic
Software (dealer only), or testing may be done manually using the procedures provided.
80% of all EFI problems are caused by wiring harness connections.
For the purpose of troubleshooting difficult running issues, a known-good ECU from another Polaris ATV EFI of the same
model may be used without damaging system or engine components.
Never attempt to service any fuel system component while engine is running or ignition switch is "on."
Cleanliness is essential and must be maintained at all times when servicing or working on the EFI system. Dirt, even in
small quantities, can cause significant problems.
Do not use compressed air if the system is open. Cover any parts removed and wrap any open joints with plastic if they will
remain open for any length of time. New parts should be removed from their protective packaging just prior to installation.
Clean any connector before opening to prevent dirt from entering the system.
Although every precaution has been taken to prevent water intrusion failure, avoid direct water or spray contact with
system components. 4
Do not disconnect or reconnect the wiring harness connector to the control unit or any individual components with the
ignition "on." This can send a damaging voltage spike through the ECU.
Do not allow the battery cables to touch opposing terminals. When connecting battery cables attach the positive (+) cable to
positive (+) battery terminal first, followed by negative (-) cable to negative (-) battery terminal.
Never start the engine when the cables are loose or poorly connected to the battery terminals.
Never disconnect battery while engine is running.
Never use a battery boost-pack to start the engine.
Do not charge battery with key switch "on."
Always disconnect negative (-) battery cable lead before charging battery.
Always unplug ECU from the wire harness before performing any welding on the ATV.
4.3
FUEL INJECTION
EFI System Exploded View
1. Electronic Control Unit (ECU)
2. Intake Air Temperature/Barometric
Air Pressure Sensor (T-BAP)
3. Crankshaft Position Sensor (CPS)
4. Fuel Injectors
5. Fuel Filter
6. Fuel Pump/Tank Assy.
7 Fuel Rail
8. Engine Coolant Sensor (ECT)
9. Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
10. Throttle Body
4
5 8
4
7
2
10
4.4
FUEL INJECTION
EFI System Component Locations 11. Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor (ECT)
11
10
4
2. Intake Air Temperature and Barometric Air Pressure
Sensor (T-BAP)
3. Crankshaft Position Sensor (CPS)
4. Fuel Injectors
5. 2 Fuel Filters (1 located in tank, 1 under front cab cover not
pictured)
6. Fuel Pump / Regulator / Gauge Sender Assembly (located
In tank as an assembly
7. Fuel Rail
8. Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
9. Throttle Body
10. Wire Harness Assembly
2 4&7
8&9
4.5
FUEL INJECTION
Fuel Tank Assembly Fuel Lines - Quick Connect
1 2 Sportsman 700/800 EFI models use quick connect fuel lines.
Refer to the steps below for fuel line removal.
Fuel Flow
Squeeze Connector Tabs
Fuel Tank
External Fuel
Filter - 10 micron
* component
located in fuel tank
4.6
FUEL INJECTION
ELECTRONIC FUEL INJECTION Initial Priming / Starting Procedure
NOTE: The Injection system must be purged of all
Principal Components
air prior to the initial start up, and/or any time the
The Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI) system is a complete engine system has been disassembled.
fuel and ignition management design. This system includes the
following principal components: If the EFI system is completely empty of fuel or has been
disassembled and repaired:
Fuel Pump
Fuel Rail 1. Cycle the key switch from OFF to ON 6 times,
Fuel Line(s)
Fuel Filter(s) waiting for approximately 3 seconds at each ON cycle to
Fuel Injectors allow the fuel pump to cycle and shut down.
Pressure Regulator 2. Once step 1 is completed, turn the key switch to START
Throttle Body / lntake Manifold
Engine Control Unit (ECU) until the engine starts or 5 seconds has passed.
Ignition Coils 3. If the engine failed to start, repeat step 1 for 2 more cycles
Coolant Temperature Sensor and attempt to start the engine.
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
Crankshaft Position Sensor (CPS)
Intake Air Temperature and Barometric Air
Pressure Sensor (T-BAP)
If the engine fails to start, a problem may still exist, and should
be diagnosed.
4
Wire Harness Assembly
Check Engine Light (MIL) NOTE: Accurate testing of EFI components is
recommended utilizing the Polaris Diagnostic
EFI Operation Overview Software (dealer only).
The EFI system is designed to provide peak engine performance
with optimum fuel efficiency and lowest possible emissions.
The ignition and injection functions are electronically
controlled, monitored and continually corrected during
operation to maintain peak performance.
The central component of the system is the Bosch Engine
Control Unit (ECU) which manages system operation,
determining the best combination of fuel mixture and ignition
timing for the current operating conditions.
An in-tank electric fuel pump is used to move fuel from the tank
through the fuel line and in-line fuel filter. The in-tank fuel
pressure regulator maintains a system operating pressure of 39
psi and returns any excess fuel to the tank. At the engine, fuel is
fed through the fuel rail and into the injectors, which inject into
the intake ports. The ECU controls the amount of fuel by varying
the length of time that the injectors are "on." This can range from
1.5-8.0 milliseconds depending on fuel requirements. The
controlled injection of the fuel occurs each crankshaft
revolution, or twice for each 4-stroke cycle. One-half the total
amount of fuel needed for one firing of a cylinder is injected
during each injection. When the intake valve opens, the fuel/air
mixture is drawn into the combustion chamber, ignited. and
burned.
The ECU controls the amount of fuel being injected and the
ignition timing by monitoring the primary sensor signals for air
temperature, barometric air pressure, engine temperature, speed
(RPM), and throttle position (load). These primary signals are
compared to the programming in the ECU computer chip, and
the ECU adjusts the fuel delivery and ignition timing to match
the values.
During operation the ECU has the ability to re-adjust
temporarily, providing compensation for changes in overall
engine condition and operating environment, so it will be able
to maintain the ideal air/fuel ratio.
During certain operating periods such as cold starts, warm up,
acceleration, etc., a richer air/fuel ratio is automatically
calculated by the ECU.
4.7
FUEL INJECTION
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU) Sportsman 700 / 800 EFI RPM Limit:
Hard Limit - Injector suppression occurs
Operation Overview
High: 6500
The ECU is the brain or central processing computer of the
entire EFI fuel/ignition management system. During operation, Low: 6500
sensors continuously gather data which is relayed through the
wiring harness to input circuits within the ECU. Signals to the Neutral: 6500
ECU include: ignition (on/off), crankshaft position and speed
(RPM), throttle position, engine coolant temperature, air Reverse: 6500
temperature, intake manifold air pressure and battery voltage.
The ECU compares the input signals to the programmed maps Park: 6500
in its memory and determines the appropriate fuel and spark
requirements for the immediate operating conditions. The ECU Soft Limit - Timing suppression occurs
then sends output signals to set the injector duration and ignition
timing. High: None
Low: 6300
Neutral: 6300
Reverse: 6300
Park: 6300
ECU Service
Never attempt to disassemble the ECU. It is sealed to prevent
damage to internal components. Warranty is void if the case is
opened or tampered with in any way.
All operating and control functions within the ECU are pre-set.
No internal servicing or readjustment may be performed. If a
problem is encountered, and you determine the ECU to be
faulty, contact the Polaris Service Department for specific
During operation, the ECU continually performs a diagnostic handling instructions. Do not replace the ECU without factory
check of itself, each of the sensors, and system performance. If authorization.
a fault is detected, the ECU turns on the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) (Check Engine Light) on the speedometer and The relationship between the ECU and the throttle position
stores the fault code in its fault memory. Depending on the sensor (TPS) is very critical to proper system operation. If the
significance or severity of the fault, normal operation may TPS is faulty, or the mounting position of the TPS to the throttle
continue, or "Fail-Safe" operation (slowed speed, richer body is altered, the TPS must be re-initialized.
running) may be initiated. A technician can access the stored
fault code using a blink code diagnosis flashed out through the For the purpose of troubleshooting, a known-good ECU from
Instrument cluster. The ECU requires a minimum of 7.0 volts to another Polaris ATV EFI of the same model may be used
operate. The memory in the ECU is operational the moment the without system or engine component damage.
battery cables are connected.
To prevent engine over-speed and possible failure, a rev- ECU Replacement
limiting feature is programmed into the ECU. If the maximum
RPM limit (6500) is exceeded, the ECU suppresses the injection 1. Remove the retaining screws (2) holding the ECU.
signals, cutting off the fuel flow. This process repeats it self in 2. With the Ignition turned off, disconnect the wire harness
rapid succession, limiting operation to the preset maximum. from the ECU.
3. To install, reverse the procedures, reapply a small amount
of dielectric grease to the connector if desired. Tighten
screws to specification.
=T
ECU Retaining Screws
10 in. lbs. (1.1 Nm)
4.8
FUEL INJECTION
FUEL PUMP Fuel Pump Test
NOTE: FUEL GAUGE SENDER TEST - To test fuel
Operation Overview
gauge sender function, refer to Chapter 10.
NOTE: All EFI units utilize quick connect lines.
The fuel pump/tank assembly is non-serviceable and must be
An electric fuel pump assembly is used to transfer fuel to the EFI replaced if determined to be faulty. If a fuel delivery problem is
system from inside the fuel tank. This assembly includes the fuel suspected, make certain the filters are not plugged, that the
pump, regulator and fuel gauge sender. The pump is rated for a pump is being activated through the ECU, all electrical
minimum output of 25 liters per hour at 39 psi and has a non- connections are properly secured, the fuses are good, and a
serviceable internal 30-micron filter. In addition, the pump has minimum of 7.0 volts is being supplied. If during starting the
a replaceable 10-micron filter attached to the pump outlet, battery voltage drops below 7.0 volts, the ECU will fail to
which is located under the strut mount. operate the system.
Fuel pump not
replaceable, picture
for reference only. WARNING
When the key switch is turned to "ON", the ECU activates the
fuel pump, which pressurizes the system for start-up.
The ECU switches off the pump preventing the continued
delivery of fuel in these instances:
Normal Fuel Pressure: 39 psi. 3
If the key switch is not promptly turned to the "start"
position.
2. Turn on the key switch to activate the pump and check the
If the engine fails to start, or
system pressure on the gauge. If system pressure of 39 psi
If the engine is stopped with the key switch "on" (as in 3 is observed, the ignition switch, ECU, fuel pump, and
the case of an accident) pressure regulator are working properly. Turn the key
In these situations, the check engine light will go on, but will switch off and depress the valve button on the tester to
turn off after 4 cranking revolutions if system function is OK. relieve the system pressure.
Once the engine is running, the fuel pump remains on. NOTE: If the pressure is too high or too low, replace
the fuel tank assembly.
4.9
FUEL INJECTION
3. If the pump did not activate (Step 2), disconnect the plug 3. Remove the clamps on the PVT intake duct and remove the
from the fuel pump. Connect a DC voltmeter across PVT duct.
terminals A and C in the plug, turn on the key switch
and observe if a minimum of 7 volts is present. If voltage
is between 7 and 14, turn key switch off and connect an
ohmmeter between the terminals A and C' on the pump
to check for continuity.
NOTE: If there was no continuity between the pump
terminals, replace the fuel tank assembly.
WARNING
5. With all the body panels removed from the front of the ATV
Always wear safety equipment when working with and the gas tank exposed, disconnect the pump wiring
high pressure or flammable fluids. Failure to do so harness.
could result in serious injury or complications.
WARNING
NOTE: The fuel pump cannot be replaced as an
individual part, the entire fuel pump and fuel tank is Wear safety equipment while performing this
replaced as an assembly. Refer to your parts book procedure, failure to do so could result in serious
for the proper part number. injuries.
4.10
FUEL INJECTION
6. Relieve the fuel pressure at the fuel test valve (arrow). 8. Remove the air box cover and remove the two gas tank
mounting bolts at the rear of the gas tank.
4
7. Loosen the fuel tank hose and pull the fuel line from
the tank. NOTE: A small amount of fuel may come 9. Carefully pull the fuel tank out of the frame. Keep the fuel
out of the fuel line or tank. Plug the fuel line and tank tank horizontal during removal, this will keep the fuel in the
inlet or use a shop towel during removal. tank from spilling out the top inlet.
NOTE: A small amount of fuel may come out of the FUEL PUMP TANK INSTALLATION
fuel line or tank. Plug the fuel line and tank inlet or
use a shop towel during removal. 1. Reinstall the pump/tank assembly.
2. Reconnect the sender wiring harness and route the harness
properly. Install the fuel line and tighten the fuel line
Fuel Line
clamp.
3. Reinstall the two fuel tank mounting bolts at back of tank.
4. Reinstall the PVT intake duct, gas tank vent line, front cab
assembly, and side panels.
NOTE: Properly route the gas tank vent line, use
tape to secure the vent line in place. (See Pg. 4.10).
Fuel Pump 5. Reconnect the negative battery cable. Test the sender for
proper operation.
WARNING
4.11
FUEL INJECTION
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR FUEL FILTERS
Operation Overview General Information
The fuel pressure regulator maintains the required operating NOTE: All EFI units utilize quick connect fuel lines.
system pressure of 39 psi + 3psi. A rubber-fiber diaphragm
divides the regulator into two separate sections-, the fuel EFI Engines use a non-serviceable, high-volume, high-
chamber and the pressure regulating chamber. The pressure pressure, 30-micron internal fuel pump filter and a replaceable
regulating spring presses against the valve holder (part of the 10-micron, in-line fuel filter.
diaphragm), pressing the valve against the valve seat. The
combination of atmospheric pressure and regulating spring
tension equals the desired operating pressure. Any time the fuel
pressure against the bottom of the diaphragm exceeds the
desired (top) pressure, the valve opens, relieving the excess 10 Micron Filter
pressure, returning the excess fuel back to the tank.
4.12
FUEL INJECTION
FUEL INJECTORS NOTE: Do not apply voltage directly to the fuel
injector(s). Excessive voltage will burn out the
injector(s). Do not ground the injector(s) with the
Operation Overview ignition on." lnjector(s) will open/turn on if relay is
energized.
NOTE: All EFI units utilize quick connect fuel lines.
If an injector is not operating, it can indicate either a bad injector,
The fuel injectors mount into the intake manifold, and the fuel or a wiring/electrical connection problem. Check as follows:
rail attaches to them at the top end. Replaceable O-Rings on both
ends of the injector prevent external fuel leaks and also insulate Injector leakage is very unlikely, but in rare instances it can be
it from heat and vibration. internal (past the tip of the valve needle), or external (weeping
around the injector body). The loss of system pressure from the
leakage can cause hot restart problems and longer cranking
times.
Injector problems due to dirt or clogging are unlikely due to the
design of the injectors, the high fuel pressure, the use of filters
and the detergent additives in the gasoline. Symptoms that could
be caused by dirty/clogged injectors include rough idle,
hesitation/stumble during acceleration, or triggering of fault
codes related to fuel delivery. Injector clogging is usually caused
by a buildup of deposits on the director plate, restricting the flow
4
of fuel, resulting in a poor spray pattern. Some contributing
factors to injector clogging include; dirty air filters, higher than
normal operating temperatures, short operating intervals and
Injector dirty, incorrect, or poor quality fuel. Cleaning of clogged
injectors is not recommended; they should be replaced.
Additives and higher grades of fuel can be used as a preventative
measure if clogging has been a problem.
When the key switch is on, the fuel rail is pressurized, and
voltage is present at the injector. At the proper instant, the ECU Fuel Injector Replacement
completes the ground circuit, energizing the injector. The valve
needle in the injector is opened electromagnetically, and the 1. Engine must be cool. Depressurize fuel system through
pressure in the fuel rail forces fuel down through the inside. The test valve in fuel rail.
director plate at the tip of the injector (see inset) contains a 2. Remove the front fender assembly and fuel tank.
series of calibrated openings which directs the fuel into the
intake port in a cone-shaped spray pattern. 3. Thoroughly clean the area around and including the throttle
body/manifold and the injectors.
The injector is opened and closed once for each crankshaft
revolution, however only one-half the total amount of fuel 4. Disconnect the fuel injector harness(s) at the ECU.
needed for one firing is injected during each opening. The 5. Remove the fuel rail mounting screw and carefully loosen
amount of fuel injected is controlled by the ECU and determined
by the length of time the valve needle is held open, also referred / pull the rail away from the injectors.
to as the injection duration or pulse width. It may vary in 6. Reverse the procedures to install the new injector(s) and
length from 1.5-8 milliseconds depending on the speed and load reassemble. Use new O-rings any time an injector is
requirements of the engine.
removed (new replacement injectors include new O-rings).
Fuel Injector Service Lubricate O-rings lightly with oil to aid installation. Torque
the fuel rail mounting screw to specification.
Injector problems typically fall into three general categories-
electrical, dirty/clogged, or leakage. An electrical problem
usually causes one or both of the injectors to stop functioning. =T
Several methods may be used to check if the injectors are
operating.
Fuel Rail Mount Screws
With the engine running at idle, feel for operational 16-20 ft. lbs. (22.6-27 Nm)
vibration, indicating that they are opening and closing.
When temperatures prohibit touching, listen for a
buzzing or clicking sound with a screwdriver or
mechanic's stethoscope.
Disconnect the electrical connector from an injector and
listen for a change in idle performance (only running on
one cylinder) or a change in injector noise or vibration.
4.13
FUEL INJECTION
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR 3. Disconnect speed sensor connector from wiring harness.
(CPS) (the connector with one heavy black lead) Viewing the
connector with dual aligning rails on top, test resistance
Operation Overview between the terminals. A reading of 560 10% should
again be obtained.
The engine speed sensor is essential to engine operation, NOTE: If the resistance is incorrect, remove the
constantly monitoring the rotational speed (RPM) and position
of the crankshaft. screw securing the sensor to the mounting bracket
and replace the sensor. If the resistance in step 2
was incorrect, but the resistance of the sensor alone
Crank Sensor was correct, test the main harness circuit between
the sensor connector terminals and the
corresponding pin terminals in the main connector.
Correct any observed problem, reconnect the
sensor, and perform step 2 again.
4.14
FUEL INJECTION
TEMPERATURE / BAROMETRIC AIR THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (TPS)
PRESSURE SENSOR (T-BAP)
Operation Overview
Operation Overview
The throttle position sensor (TPS) is used to indicate throttle
Mounted on the throttle body intake, the temperature and plate angle to the ECU.
barometric air pressure sensor (T-BAP) performs two functions
in one unit. Mounted on the throttle body and operated directly off the end
of the throttle shaft, the TPS works like a rheostat, varying the
voltage signal to the ECU in direct correlation to the angle of the
throttle plate. This signal is processed by the ECU and compared
to the internal pre-programmed maps to determine the required
fuel and ignition settings for the amount of engine load.
NOTE: The correct position of the TPS is
established and set at the factory. Do not loosen the
TPS or alter the mounting position. If the TPS is
repositioned, replaced or loosened it must be re-
calibrated. 4
Throttle Position Sensor Replacement
The correct position of the TPS is established and set at the
factory. If the TPS is repositioned, replaced or loosened it must
Air passing through the intake is measured by the T-BAP and be re-calibrated.
relayed to the ECU. These signals, comprised of separate air
temperature and barometric air pressure readings, are processed
by the ECU and compared to it's programming for determining
the fuel and ignition requirements during operation.
4.15
FUEL INJECTION
Throttle Position Sensor Test low, verify the 9 volt battery is good or try a new 9 volt
battery.
The throttle position sensor (TPS) is a non-serviceable item. If
it is faulty, it must be replaced. It can be tested using the
following method:
Set up the TPS Test Adapter Harness (PU-47082),
according to the instructions. Make sure that the 9 volt
battery is new. Figure 2.
STEP 1
Establishing zero offset voltage: This step is crucial as it sets
With the test leads connected and the meter set, move the TPS position using a fixed physical stop. This will insure
the throttle open and closed slowly while reading the that the correct offset voltage is reached once the correct throttle
display. The voltage should increase smoothly with no body flow is set.
jumps or decreases when the throttle is applied.
If the sensor does not function correctly, replace it.
CORRECT REFERENCE VOLTAGE
Throttle Plate
Must Be Closed
4.16
FUEL INJECTION
With engine off, back out air flow screw until it no STEP 2
longer is in contact with throttle plate cam. The throttle
plate should seal off throttle bore completely. Establishing correct flow: Now that the zero offset voltage has
been set, you can now set the throttle body to the correct air flow
Back Air Flow Screw Out Until No value.
Contact is Made
With voltmeter still attached to the TPS Test Adapter
Harness (PU-47082), turn the air flow adjustment
screw until the voltmeter reads .710 .01 volts. The
throttle body is now adjusted to the correct flow value
Figure 3.
.528
Fig. 2
Reconnect the TPS harness lead
Reinstall throttle cable on throttle cam and install cover.
Using a voltmeter attached to the TPS Tester Harness Adjust cable freeplay.
(PU-47082), check the voltage output of the TPS. It
should read .528 .01 volts.
If it does not read .528 .01 volts, loosen the screw
holding the TPS to the throttle body. Rotate TPS until
voltmeter reads .528 .01 volts.
Retighten TPS mounting screw, and verify the voltage
did not change. If changed, repeat the previous steps.
4.17
FUEL INJECTION
ENGINE TEMPERATURE SENSOR Engine Temperature Sensor Test
Operation Overview
Mounted on the cylinder, the engine temperature sensor
measures coolant temperature. The engine temperature sensor
is a Negative Temperature Coefficient (NTC) type sensor, as the
temperature increases the resistance decreases.
TEMPERATURE F
RESISTANCE
(C)
Refer to Chapter 10 for testing. Standard resistance readings
according to temperature:
68 F (20 C) 2.5 k 6%
Coolant passes through the cylinder and by the sensor probe,
varying a resistance reading which is relayed to the ECU. This 212 F (100 C) 0.186 k 2%
signal is processed by the ECU and compared to it's
programming for determining the fuel and ignition
requirements during operation. The ECU also uses this signal to Engine Temperature Sensor Replacement
determine when to activate the fan during operation. If for any
reason the engine temperature sensor circuit is interrupted, the 1. Drain coolant to level below sensor
fan will default to ON. 2. Disconnect sensor from engine harness.
3. Using a wrench, remove and replace the sensor, applying
a light coating of thread sealant to aid installation.
4. Torque the sensor to specification.
=T
Engine Temperature Sensor Torque:
18 ft. lbs. (25 Nm)
4.18
FUEL INJECTION
TROUBLESHOOTING NOTE: To clear codes manually, disconnect the
positive battery lead for 20 seconds.
Diagnostics Using Blink Codes
To enable the blink codes, turn the ignition from OFF to ON
3 times, leaving it 'on' the 3rd time, within 5 seconds. ON
4.19
FUEL INJECTION
EFI Troubleshooting Poor Idle
Fuel Starvation / Lean Mixture Symptom: Idle Too High (If greater than 1300 RPM when
engine is warm)
Symptoms: Hard start or no start, bog, backfire, popping
through intake / exhaust, hesitation, detonation, low power, Throttle stop screw set incorrect
spark plug erosion, engine runs hot, surging, high idle, idle
speed erratic. Throttle cable sticking, improperly adjusted, routed
incorrectly
No fuel in tank
Symptom: Idle Too Low (if less than 900 RPM when engine is
Restricted tank vent, or routed improperly warm)
4.20
FUEL INJECTION
EFI CIRCUIT - Power On
4.21
FUEL INJECTION
EFI CIRCUIT - Fuel Pump
4.22
FUEL INJECTION
EFI CIRCUIT - Temperature - Barometric Air Pressure Sensor
4.23
FUEL INJECTION
EFI CIRCUIT - Malfunction Indicator Light
4.24
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
CHAPTER 5
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
DECAL REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
PLASTIC INSERT REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3
BODY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
SIDE PANEL REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
FRONT COVER REMOVAL / INSTALLATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
FOOT WELL REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5
X2 FOOT WELL REMOVAL / INSTALLATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5
FRONT STORAGE REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6
FRONT STORAGE INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
SPORTSMAN REAR RACK REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
FRONT CAB/FENDER REMOVAL/INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
SPORTSMAN REAR CAB / FENDER REMOVAL / INSTALLATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10
5
X2 REAR QUARTER PANEL REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10
SPORTSMAN REAR STORAGE REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11
RADIATOR SCREEN REMOVAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11
SPORTSMAN BODY ASSEMBLY EXPLODED VIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12
X2 BODY ASSEMBLY EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.13
BODY RACK EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.14
HEADLIGHT POD EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.15
STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.16
HANDLEBAR BLOCK INSTALLATION PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.16
STEERING / A-ARM EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.17
A-ARM REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.18
BALL JOINT REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.19
STEERING POST REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
STEERING POST ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
SUSPENSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
FRONT STRUT CARTRIDGE REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
STRUT ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.21
SPORTSMAN REAR SUSPENSION ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.22
X2 REAR SUSPENSION EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.23
X2 TORSION BAR EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.24
X2 CARGO BOX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.25
EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.25
REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.26
X2 SEAT ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.28
EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.28
X2 SEAT OPERATION - CONFIGURING CARGO BOX FOR PASSENGER RIDING . 5.29
DRIVER SEAT BACKREST REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
PASSENGER SEAT BACKREST REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
5.1
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
GENERAL INFORMATION Special Tools
FT.LBS.
2870871 Ball Joint Replacement Tool
COMPONENT NM
(IN.LBS.) 2870872 Shock Spanner Wrench
Front Hug Nut 70 95 Shock Absorber Spring Compression
2870623
Front A-Arm Attaching Bolt 30 41 Tool
Front A-Arm Ball Joint Stud Nut 25 35 2871572 Strut Rod Wrench
5.2
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Plastic Insert Removal / Installation 3. To install the inserts, press outside insert (B) into the hole.
Press inside insert (A) until it snaps into place.
Some Polaris ATVs use a two piece plastic insert in place of a
metal screw. The plastic inserts are simple to remove and install. NOTE: The outside insert (B) should be flush
surface after installation.
1. Use a a pair of diagonal side cutters to lift the plastic insert
(A) until you feel some slight pressure or lift the insert
approximately 1/4" (6.35 mm). Apply just enough
pressure on the side cutters to lift up on the insert. DO
NOT apply too much pressure on the side cutters, or
damage to the insert will occur.
The inside insert (A) should be flush with the top of the outside
insert (B). 5
A
2. Next, use the diagonal side cutters under outside insert (B)
to completely remove the assembly. NOTE: The inside B
insert (A) will still be installed in the outside insert (B).
5.3
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
BODY 3. Reinstall the side panel by reversing the removal procedure.
Step 3
Side Panel Removal
Side panel removal is quick and easy, use the following
instructions for removal and installation.
1. Remove seat by releasing the latch and lifting up on the
seat.
Step 1
2. Grasp the rear of the side panel near the rear cab. With a
firm motion, pull the panel outward to disengage the side
panel from the grommet. Pull the panel downward and
rearward to remove it from the ATV.
Step 2
3. To install the front cover, insert the tabs of the front cover
into the inserts of the cab. Make sure the tabs are aligned
with the slots. Then press the rear tabs into the slots.
5.4
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Foot Well Removal / Installation X2 Foot Well Removal / Installation
1. Remove the four plastic inserts (A) that secure the wheel 1. Remove the four plastic inserts (A) that secure the wheel
well to the front and rear cabs. (See PLASTIC INSERT well to the front and rear cabs. (See PLASTIC INSERT
REMOVAL / INSTALLATION for help). REMOVAL / INSTALLATION for help).
2. Remove the four screws (B) from the bottom of the foot 2. Remove the six screws (B) from the bottom of the foot well.
well. Remove the footwell. Remove the footwell.
5
18 in.lbs. (
A A
A A
B
B
3. Reverse the removal procedures to install the foot well. Be 3. Reverse the removal procedures to install the foot well. Be
sure to properly align the cab ends into the foot wells upon sure to properly align the cab ends into the foot wells upon
reassembly. reassembly.
5.5
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Front Storage Removal 2. Remove the four bolts that secure the storage rack to the
frame.
Front Storage
Remove Bolts
3. Remove the two (T25) screws that secure the storage box
to the front fender well areas (each side).
Remove Bolts
T-25 Screws
A
4. Remove the two (T25) screws that secure the outside of the
storage box to the front fenders (each side).
T-25 Screws
5.6
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Winch Installation Area 6. Remove the front headlights (C) or simply disconnect the
electric connector (D) before removing the front plastic
5. Remove the front cover piece by lifting up on sides of the bumper.
two locking tabs as shown. Pull the tabs out of the notches
and lift up on the cover piece.
D
C
To install the front cover place top lip of the cover into and lift
up to remove.
2. Press in Tabs
5.7
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Front Storage Installation 8. Install the front radiator cap cover (E) .
A Front Storage
B E
C inserts Sportsman Rear Rack Removal / Installation
C
B A B
A
A C
D
T-25 Screw A
A. 14 ft.lbs. (19 Nm) C. 10 in.lbs. (1.13 Nm) B
B. 10 in.lbs. (1.13 Nm) D. 24 in.lbs (2.7 Nm)
5.8
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
3. Place spacers on frame. 3. Remove the two screws (B) that secure the front cab to the
frame in the fuel tank mount area.
6. Remove the fuel cap and place a clean lint free shop towel
into the tank neck to keep any debris from falling into the
tank.
A 7. The front cab should now slide back over the fuel tank and
fuel tank neck.
NOTE: When removing the front cab use caution so
the plastic cab does not scratch or get caught on
other components.
=T
Cab to Frame Screws
24 in.lbs. (2.7 Nm)
5.9
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Sportsman Rear Cab / Fender Removal / 4. Disconnect the rear lights by pulling the locks on each side
Installation and removing the connectors. Lift the rear cab from the
frame.
1. Follow the REAR RACK REMOVAL procedure to
remove the rear rack.
2. Remove the three screws (A) (T-25) that secure the rear cab
to the storage container.
Remove Connectors
A Lock
T-25 - 6 in.lbs.
5.10
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Sportsman Rear Storage Removal / Radiator Screen Removal
Installation
1. Pull out slightly on the top of the radiator screen.
1. Follow the REAR RACK REMOVAL and REAR 2. With the top free, pull out on the bottom of the screen to
CAB REMOVAL procedure to remove the rear storage remove the screen.
compartment. After the rear cab is removed the storage 3. To install the screen, simply press the tabs on the screen
compartment comes out. back into the mounting grommets. Be sure the screen is
2. Remove the two plastic inserts that hold the rear storage securely in place.
compartment in place.
3. For installation, reverse the removal steps.
4. Torque the three T-25 screws that hold the rear storage to
the rear cab to specification.
=T
T-25 Screw Torque
6 in. lbs. (0.70 Nm)
5.11
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Sportsman Body Assembly Exploded View
Rear Cab Assembly Pull UP on rear of seat and
back to disengage tabs at front
of seat.
Seat Latch
Storage
Frame
Front Cover
Support
Front Cab
Splash Shields
5.12
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 Body Assembly Exploded View
Rear Cab Assembly
Footwell
RH Rear Cab
Front Cover
Support
Front Cab
Splash Shields
5.13
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Body / Rack Exploded Views
Rack Rails
Sportsman Only
Rear Rack
Rack Rails
Frame
Box Assembly
Cover
Panel
5.14
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Headlight Pod Exploded View
Worklight Switch
A
Instrument
Cluster F
A
ETC
Brake
G
5
D
C
E
Wheel Speed Sensor - Sportsman
C (X2 Speed Sensor Located on Transmission)
Disassembly Assembly
Remove two side Phillips screws (A) Install bottom of pod onto handlebar and secure to
brackets
Remove one rear Phillips screw (B)
Install key switch, choke cable, and headlight
Lift top half of pod
Connect 12Vdc power outlet (where applicable)
Disconnect instrument cluster wire connectors
Connect headlight
Disconnect work light switch connector
Connect instrument cluster connectors to instrument
Disconnect 12Vdc power plug (G) cluster
Disconnect headlight harness Install top of pod onto bottom half, making sure
interlocking tabs mate properly
Remove ignition switch (C) and choke cable (D)
Install two side Phillips screws
Remove headlight (F) with adjuster
Install one rear Phillips screw
Remove two screws securing bottom half of pod (E)
To adjust headlight, refer to procedure outlined in
Chapter 2
5.15
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
STEERING
Handlebar Block Installation Procedure
1. The pin (A) on the bottom side of the top handlebar block faces down and to the front of the ATV.
2. The bottom handle bar block has a side with 3 holes, the side with 3 holes faces up and to the front of the ATV.
3. Align the pin (A) in the top block with the middle hole (B) in the bottom block for proper installation. The pin (A) and middle
hole (B) should face the front of the ATV.
4. Install the pin side bolts first and evenly tighten the bolts down. Evenly torque the 2 front bolts to specification.
=T
Handle Bar Bolt Torque
11-13 ft.lbs.(15-18 Nm)
5. Install the rear bolts and tighten evenly. Evenly torque the 2 rear bolts to specification.
NOTE: There will be a slight gap on the backside of the blocks after the procedure is performed.
5.16
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Steering / A-arm Exploded View
Steering Post
25-30 ft.lbs.
(35-41 Nm)
NOTE: To avoid damage to tie rods and other steering components, be sure to install tie rod end bolts in the
proper direction. The steering post arm bolt (B) points up; the rod end bolts (A) point down. Verify inner rod
ends are placed between the steering post arms.
5.17
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
A-Arm Replacement
1. Elevate and safely support vehicle with weight removed from front wheel(s).
2. Remove cotter pin from ball joint stud at wheel end of A-arm and loosen nut until it is flush with end of stud.
3. Using a soft face hammer, tap nut to loosen A-arm from bolt. Remove nut and A-arm from hub strut assembly.
4. Loosen two bolts on A-arm tube by alternating each about 1/3 of the way until A-arm can be removed.
5. Examine A-arm shaft. Replace if worn. Discard hardware.
6. Insert A-arm shaft into new A-arm.
7. Install CV joint shields.
8. Install new A-arm assembly onto vehicle frame. Torque new bolts to specification.
=T
A-Arm Bolt Torque: 30 ft. lbs. (41.4 Nm)
WARNING
9. Attach A-arm to hub strut assembly. Tighten ball joint nut to specification. If cotter pin holes are not aligned, tighten nut
slightly to align. Install a new cotter pin with open ends toward rear of machine. Bend both ends in opposite directions around nut
=T
Ball Joint Nut Torque: 25 ft. lbs. (35 Nm)
WARNING
5.18
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Ball Joint Replacement 8. Install puller guide (G) with extension cap (H).
9. Apply grease to extension cap and threads of puller bolt to
NOTE: Refer to the illustration on the previous page
ease removal.
for this procedure.
10. Thread bolt (J) with nut (I) onto ball joint stud as shown.
1. Loosen front wheel nuts slightly. 11. Apply heat to ease removal.
2. Elevate and safely support machine under footrest/frame 12. Hold bolt (J) and turn nut (I) clockwise until ball joint is
area. removed from strut housing.
CAUTION
K
Serious injury may result if machine tips or falls. Be
sure machine is secure before beginning this
service procedure.
F 5
L
E 13. To install a new ball joint, Remove extension cap and
B attach puller guide using short bolts provided in the kit.
14. Remove extension cap and attach puller guide using short
A bolts provided in the kit.
D 15. Insert new ball joint (K) into driver (L).
4. Remove cotter pin (A) from ball joint castle nut (B). 16. Slide ball joint/driver assembly into guide.
5. Remove castle nut (B) and separate A-arm (C) from ball 17. Apply heat to ease installation.
joint stud. 18. Drive new joint into strut housing until fully seated.
6. Remove screws (D) and ball joint retaining plate (E). 19. Apply Loctite 242 (PN 2871949) to threads of retaining
7. Use the Ball Joint Replacement Tool (PN 2870871), plate screws or install new screws with pre-applied locking
remove ball joint (F) from strut housing. Refer to photos. agent. Torque screws to specification.
=T
G
H Retaining Screw Torque: 8 ft. lbs. (11 Nm)
21. Reinstall cotter pin with open ends toward rear of machine.
5.19
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Steering Post Removal SUSPENSION
1. Remove the front cab.
Front Strut Cartridge Replacement
2. Remove the handle bar pod.
3. Remove the handle bar. NOTE: Refer to illustration on following page.
4. Remove the fuel tank bracket assembly.
1. Hold strut rod and remove top nut.
5. Remove the steering tie rod ends from the steering bracket.
2. Remove upper strut pivot assembly.
Note the orientation of the fasteners and bracket on the
steering assembly.
6. Remove the steering post nut (A) at the mount plate.
Strut Rod Wrench:
(PN 2871572)
7. Remove the top steering bracket . Strut Spring Compressor Tools:
8. Remove the steering post. (PN 2871573) and (PN 2871574)
Steering Post Assembly 3. Compress spring using any commercially available spring
compressor tool and remove the spacer nut.
4. Remove coil spring and collapse strut cartridge.
5. Remove two pinch bolts from strut casting.
6. Remove strut cartridge.
7. Install cartridge until bottomed in strut casting.
8. Install pinch bolts with wire clamp(s). Torque pinch bolts
to specification.
12 ft.lbs. (16 Nm)
=T
Pinch Bolt Torque:
15 ft. lbs. (21 Nm)
=T
Strut Rod Nut Torque:
15 ft. lbs. (21 Nm)
5.20
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Strut Assembly
Nut - 15 ft.lbs.
(21 Nm)
Strut Bumper
Spacer Rubber
Washer
Strut
Upper Pivot Ball
Spacer Nut
Clamp
Lower Pivot Ball Washer
18 ft.lbs. (25 Nm)
5
Bolts
Spring
Brake Caliper
Hubstrut Bearing
Retaining Ring
5.21
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Sportsman Rear Suspension Assembly
Stabilizer Bar
1
35 ft.lbs. (48 Nm)
35 ft.lbs.
(48 Nm)
30 ft.lbs.
(41 Nm)
35 ft.lbs. (48 Nm)
50 ft.lbs.
(68 Nm) Rear Shock
Lower Control Arm
30 ft.lbs.
(41 Nm)
5.22
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 Rear Suspension Exploded View
Rear Shock
Bushings
5
Control Arm Pivot Bracket
Boot Shield
A-Arm Shaft
Grease Zerk
5.23
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 Torsion Bar Exploded View
Stabilizer Bushing
Bushing
Torsion Mount
Linkage Asm.
5.24
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 CARGO BOX
Exploded View
5.25
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Removal / Installation 3. Disconnect the two wire harnesses connected to each of
the taillights.
IMPORTANT: Before attempting to remove the cargo
box, be sure that the cargo box is not set up for 2-UP
riding. The passenger backrest should be face down
in the cargo box and the driver seat backrest should
be locked into position.
1. Open the tailgate and remove the 2 torx head screws (A)
securing the rear taillights on each side of the cargo box as
illustrated below.
CAUTION
2. Remove the taillight assembly from the cargo box. 4. Carefully pull out the red locking tab on the connector.
5. Once the red tab is pulled out, press in on the black tab and
pull out to disconnect harness.
Black Tab
Red Tab
5.26
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
6. Lift up firmly in the cargo box release lever on either side 9. Carefully remove the cargo box from the ATV.
of the ATV.
10. Reverse the removal steps to reinstall the cargo box. Refer
to the standard fastener torque values in Chapter 1 during
7. Remove the four bolts attaching the rear of the cargo box assembly.
to the frame. There are two on each side.
Clip Pin
5.27
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 SEAT ASSEMBLY
Exploded Views
5.28
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
X2 Seat Operation - Configuring Cargo Box 4. Fold the driver seat backrest down into place to serve as the
For Passenger Riding passenger seat bottom.
Passenger Backrest
1. Unlatch the driver seat backrest by turning the engagement
knobs on each side in the directions shown below.
A
B
Passenger Backrest
3. Lift the passenger backrest up and into place, then lay the
driver seat backrest down into place
A
B
5.29
BODY / STEERING / SUSPENSION
Driver Seat Backrest Removal / Installation 2. Lift up on the latch for the passenger seat bottom and lock
it in the upright position as shown below.
1. Configure the seating for 2-UP riding. With the passenger
seat bottom in place, remove the two screws retaining the
seat bottom.
2. Remove the two pivot pins holding the seat bottom to the
frame and then lift up on the seat bottom to remove.
5.30
CLUTCH SYSTEM
CHAPTER 6
CLUTCH SYSTEM
SPECIAL TOOLS AND SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
COMPONENT FASTENER TORQUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
PVT EXPLODED VIEWS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
PVT SEALING AND DUCTING COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
DRIVE CLUTCH EXPLODED VIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
ENGINE BRAKING SYSTEM (EBS) EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4
EBS DRIVEN CLUTCH EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.5
PVT SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
PVT OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
DRIVE CLUTCH OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
DRIVEN CLUTCH OPERATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
EBS CLUTCH OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7
PVT MAINTENANCE / INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7
DRIVE CLUTCH SPRING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8
OPTIONAL SHIFT WEIGHTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.9
PVT DRYING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.10
PVT DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.10
PVT INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.11
DRIVE BELT REMOVAL / INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.12
DRIVE BELT INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.13
CLUTCH ALIGNMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.14
CLUTCH OFFSET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.14
EBS DRIVE CLUTCH SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.15
6
DRIVE CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.15
SPIDER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.15
BUTTON TO TOWER CLEARANCE INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.17
SHIFT WEIGHT INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.17
DRIVE CLUTCH INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.17
MOVEABLE SHEAVE BUSHING INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.18
DRIVE CLUTCH BUSHING SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.18
ONE-WAY CLUTCH INSPECTION (DRIVE CLUTCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.20
DRIVE CLUTCH REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.20
EBS DRIVEN CLUTCH SERVICE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.22
DRIVEN CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.22
DRIVEN CLUTCH BUSHING REMOVAL/INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.24
EBS DRIVEN CLUTCH REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.25
STANDARD DRIVE CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.28
DRIVE CLUTCH DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.28
SPIDER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.29
BUTTON TO TOWER CLEARANCE INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.30
SHIFT WEIGHT INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.30
DRIVE CLUTCH REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.31
SHEAVE / BUSHING INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.32
STANDARD DRIVEN CLUTCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.33
DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.33
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.33
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.34
PVT TROUBLESHOOTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.35
OVERHEATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.35
PROBLEM, CAUSE AND REMEDY CHART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.36
6.1
CLUTCH SYSTEM
SPECIAL TOOLS AND Component Fastener Torques
SPECIFICATIONS
FT.LBS.
Special Tools COMPONENT NM
(IN.LBS.)
6.2
CLUTCH SYSTEM
PVT EXPLODED VIEWS
PVT Sealing And Ducting Components
EBS
One Way Clutch
Deluxe Models
NON-EBS
Standard Models
6.3
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Driven Clutch Exploded Views (Standard and Deluxe)
DELUXE - EBS
6.4
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Engine Braking System (EBS) Exploded View
Spacer
Clutch Rollers
Spider Assembly
Spider Lock Nut
Compression Spring
Bushing Cover
6
Clutch Shaft
Coil Spring
Spacer Washer
Bearing
Sheaves
Retaining Rings
6.5
CLUTCH SYSTEM
PVT SYSTEM Driven Clutch Operation
Driven clutches primarily sense torque, opening and closing
PVT Operation Overview according to the forces applied to it from the drive belt and the
transmission input shaft. If the torque resistance at the
transmission input shaft is greater than the load from the drive
WARNING belt, the drive belt is kept at the outer diameter of the driven
clutch sheaves.
All PVT maintenance or repairs should be
performed only by a certified Polaris Master Service As engine RPM and horsepower increase, the load from the
Dealer (MSD) technician who has received the drive belt increases, resulting in the belt rotating up toward the
proper training and understands the procedures outer diameter of the drive clutch sheaves and downward into
outlined in this manual. Because of the critical the sheaves of the driven clutch. This action, which increases
the driven clutch speed, is called upshifting.
nature and precision balance incorporated into the
PVT components, it is absolutely essential that no Should the throttle setting remain the same and the vehicle is
disassembly or repair be made without factory subjected to a heavier load, the drive belt rotates back up toward
authorized special tools and service procedures. the outer diameter of the driven clutch and downward into the
sheaves of the drive clutch. This action, which decreases the
The Polaris Variable Transmission (PVT) consists of three driven clutch speed, is called backshifting.
major assemblies: 1) The Drive Clutch; 2) The Driven Clutch;
and 3) The Drive Belt. The internal components of the drive In situations where loads vary (such as uphill and downhill) and
clutch and driven clutch control engagement (initial vehicle throttle settings are constant, the drive and driven clutches are
movement), clutch upshift and backshift. During the continually shifting to maintain optimum engine RPM. At full
development of a Polaris ATV, the PVT system is matched first throttle a perfectly matched PVT system should hold engine
to the engine power curve; then to average riding conditions and RPM at the peak of the power curve. This RPM should be
the vehicle's intended usage. Therefore, modifications or maintained during clutch upshift and backshift. In this respect,
variations of components at random are never recommended. the PVT system is similar to a power governor. Rather than vary
Proper clutch setup and careful inspection of existing throttle position, as a conventional governor does, the PVT
components must be the primary objective when system changes engine load requirements by either upshifting or
troubleshooting and tuning. backshifting.
At lower RPM, the drive belt rotates low in the drive clutch
sheaves. As engine RPM increases, centrifugal force causes the
drive belt to be forced upward on drive clutch sheaves.
6.6
CLUTCH SYSTEM
EBS Clutch Operation PVT Maintenance / Inspection
This EBS driven clutch provides the same engine braking Under normal operation the PVT system will provide years of
abilities as the EBS drive clutch. trouble free operation. Periodic inspection and maintenance is
required to keep the system operating at peak performance. The
following list of items should be inspected and maintained to
One-Way Clutch ensure maximum performance and service life of PVT
components. Refer to the troubleshooting checklist at the end of
this chapter for more information.
1. Drive to Driven Clutch Offset, Belt Width.
CAUTION
6.7
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Drive Clutch Spring Measuring Spring Length: With the spring resting on a flat
surface, measure its free length from the outer coil surfaces as
shown. Refer to the spring specification chart for specific free
length measurements and tolerances. Also check to see that
spring coils are parallel to one another. Distortion of the spring
indicates stress fatigue, requiring replacement.
CAUTION
6.8
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Optional Shift Weights
Shown below are optional shift weights which may be used in the PVT system. These shift weights have many different factors
designed into them for controlling engagement RPM and shifting patterns. Shift weights should not be changed or altered without
first having a thorough understanding the effects they have on belt to sheave clearance, clutch balance, engagement and shifting
characteristics.
- NLA - - NLA -
698
6.9
CLUTCH SYSTEM
PVT Drying PVT Disassembly
IMPORTANT: If operating the ATV through water, be NOTE: Some fasteners and procedures will vary.
sure to check the PVT cover and other ATV Refer to the appropriate parts manual for proper
components for water ingestion. The ATV should be
checked immediately. Refer to Owner's Manual for fasteners and fastener placement.
Safe Riding Tips.
1. Remove seat.
2. Remove or loosen cab and footwell fasteners as necessary
PVT Drain Plug to gain access to PVT outer cover.
3. Remove PVT air outlet duct hose.
4. Remove outer PVT cover screws.
5. Mark the drive belt direction of rotation and remove drive
belt. See the DRIVE BELT REMOVAL procedure later
in this chapter.
6. Remove drive clutch retaining bolt and remove drive clutch
using puller.
To drain any water that may be trapped inside the PVT cover,
simply remove the PVT drain plug and O-ring located on the
bottom of the PVT cover and let the water drain out. The PVT
drain plug is shown below.
To further expel water in the PVT cover and to dry out the PVT
system, shift the transmission to neutral and rev engine slightly
to expel the moisture. This will also air-dry the belt and clutches.
Allow engine RPM to settle to idle speed, shift transmission to
lowest available range and test for belt slippage. Repeat as
needed. Operate ATV in lowest available range for a short Drive Clutch Puller: (PN 2870506)
period of time until PVT system is dry.
Clutch Holding Wrench: (PN 9314177)
6.10
CLUTCH SYSTEM
8. Remove driven clutch offset spacers from the transmission PVT Installation
input shaft. NOTE: Remember to keep spacers in order for
proper clutch offset on reassembly. 1. Inspect PVT inner cover-to-engine seal. Replace if
cracked or damaged. Align the alignment mark on the
cover with the mark on the engine seal.
Offset Spacer
Foam Seal
B
10. Remove inner cover retaining bolts at rear of cover. C
11. Remove cover along with foam seal on back of cover or
shaft. A
=T
Inner Cover Bolt Torque (B):
12 ft. lbs. (16.6 Nm)
6.11
CLUTCH SYSTEM
7. Install clutch offset spacer(s) on transmission input shaft. Drive Belt Removal / Inspection
1. Remove outer PVT cover as described in PVT
Offset Spacer Disassembly.
2. Mark drive belt direction of rotation so that it can be
installed in the same direction. The belt is normally
positioned so part numbers are easily read.
3. To remove drive belt, apply brake, pull upward and
rearward on belt while turning the back (moveable) driven
sheave clockwise to open driven clutch sheaves. Pull out
and down on belt to slip over the driven clutch outer sheave.
=T
Driven Clutch Retaining Bolt Torque:
17 ft. lbs. (23.5 Nm)
11. Clean end of taper on crankshaft and the taper bore inside
drive clutch.
12. Install drive clutch and torque retaining bolt to
specification.
=T
Drive Clutch Retaining Bolt Torque:
40 ft. lbs. (55 Nm)
15. Reinstall PVT outer cover and secure with screws. Torque
to specification.
16. Reinstall cab/footwell assembly, panel and seat.
6.12
CLUTCH SYSTEM
6. Measure the distance where the side straight edges intersect DRIVE BELT INSTALLATION
the top, as shown in the illustration.
NOTE: Be sure to position belt so part number is easily
read. Verify new belt is seated properly in the clutches
Projected Belt Width before operating the ATV.
Belt Width:
Wear Limit 1.125" (2.86 cm)
Center
Distance
6.13
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Clutch Alignment 7. Measure belt deflection and measure offset both above and
below shaft centerlines. Adjust if necessary.
1. Remove belt and install the Clutch Offset Alignment Tool
(PN 2872292) as shown. Center Line
B
Offset Alignment
Tool (PN 2872292)
Clutch Offset
2. With tool touching rear of driven clutch inner sheave, the
IMPORTANT: Inspect clutch alignment and center
distance at point A should be 1/8. distance before adjusting offset.
NOTE: If the distance is greater than 1/8, or less
than 1/16,, clutch alignment must be adjusted as Offset is correct when rear of tool contacts rear of inner sheave
with driven clutch pushed completely inward, spacers installed
follows: (if required) on shaft and bolt torqued to specification.
3. Remove drive and driven clutch. See PVT
DIASSEMBLY at the beginning of the chapter. Spacer Washer (PN 7556401)
4. Remove PVT inner cover.
5. Loosen all engine mounts. Move front of engine to the right 1. Install alignment tool as shown. Remember to measure
or left slightly until alignment is correct. above and below the shaft centerlines.
6. Tighten engine mounts and verify alignment is correct. 2. Adjust offset by adding or removing spacer washers
between back of driven clutch and spacer.
6.14
CLUTCH SYSTEM
EBS DRIVE CLUTCH SERVICE 5. Remove and inspect spring. See Drive Clutch Spring
Specifications for spring inspection.
Drive Clutch Disassembly
Inspect Shaft
1. Using a permanent marker, mark the cover, spider, and
moveable and stationary sheaves for reference, as the cast-
in X's may not have been in alignment before disassembly.
Spider Removal
1. Remove the limiter nut using the Clutch Spider Nut Socket
(PN 2870338). Install clutch in holding fixture and loosen
the spider (counterclockwise) using Clutch Spider Install
2. Remove cover bolts evenly in a cross pattern and remove Tool (PN 2870341).
cover plate.
3. Inspect cover bushing (A). The outer cover bushing is
manufactured with a Teflon coating. Wear is determined
6
by the amount of Teflon remaining on the bushing.
6.15
CLUTCH SYSTEM
NOTE: It is important that the same number and 3. Inspect all rollers, bushings and roller pins by pulling a flat
thickness of washers are reinstalled beneath the metal rod across the roller. Turn roller with your finger. If
spider during assembly. Be sure to note the number you notice resistance, galling, or flat spots, replace rollers,
and thickness of these washers. pins and thrust washers in sets of three. Also inspect to see
if roller and bushing are separating. Bushing must fit
To maintain proper clutch balance and belt-to-sheave
clearance, be sure to reinstall original quantity and tightly in roller. Use the Roller Pin Tool (PN 2870910) to
thickness washers replace rollers and pins. Take care not to damage roller
bushing or bearing surface of the new pin during
installation.
6.16
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Button To Tower Clearance Inspection 2. Inspect the weight pivot bore and pivot bolts for wear or
galling. If weights or bolts are worn or broken, replace in
1. Inspect for any clearance between spider button to tower. sets of three with new bolts.
If clearance exists, replace all buttons and inspect surface
NOTE: A damaged shift weight is usually caused by
of towers. See Spider Removal procedure.
a damaged or stuck roller in the spider assembly.
See roller inspection, see Roller, Pin, and Thrust
Washer Inspection.
WARNING
6.17
CLUTCH SYSTEM
2. Lift one-way clutch (3) and thrustwasher (4) off shaft. Moveable Sheave Bushing Inspection
Replace as an assembly if worn, damaged, or if problems
were noted. Inspect the Teflon coating (arrow) on the moveable sheave
bushing. Inspect BOTH sheaves for signs of wear, grooving or
cracking. De-glaze surfaces with a 3M pad if needed.
= In. / mm.
6.18
CLUTCH SYSTEM
NOTE: Bushings are installed at the factory using Drive Clutch Bushing Installation
Loctite 609. In order to remove bushings it will be
1. Place main adapter (Item 8) on puller.
necessary to apply heat evenly to the area around
each bushing. Clean all residual Loctite from Puller Tool (A,B) Side Nut (C)
A toward sheave
bushing bore prior to installing new bushing.
CAUTION
6.19
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Cover Bushing Removal One-Way Clutch Inspection (Drive Clutch)
1. Install main adapter (Item 8) on puller. 1. Rotate one-way clutch clockwise (as viewed from the
cover plate side). The clutch should rotate on the shaft
Removal Tool (3) with only slight amount of drag. Verify there is no binding
Nut (C) or rough spots. When rotated counterclockwise, the clutch
should lock to the shaft without slipping. If problems are
noted in either direction, continue with disassembly.
6.20
CLUTCH SYSTEM
C) X, or the marks that were made earlier under weight 6. Install limiter nut on top of spider using the Clutch Spider
Nut Socket (PN 2870338). Torque to specification.
Reinstall shift weights using new lock nuts on the bolts.
=T
Spider Nut Torque:
15 ft. lbs. (20 Nm)
Engine
Rotation
2. Install moveable sheave onto fixed sheave.
3. Install spider spacers. Use same quantity and thickness as
were removed.
4. Compress spider buttons for each tower and install spider,
making sure that X, or the marks that were made earlier,
on spider aligns with X, or the marks that were made
5.
earlier on the moveable sheave.
Torque spider to specification using the holding fixture and
Nut on trailing side 6
spider tool. Torque with smooth motion to avoid damage
8. Reinstall cover, aligning bosses on the tower and cover.
to the stationary sheave.
Torque cover bolts evenly to specification.
Spacer Washers
CAUTION
=T
Spider Torque: =T
200 ft. lbs. (271 Nm)
Cover Screw Torque:
90 in. lbs. (10.4 Nm)
6.21
CLUTCH SYSTEM
EBS DRIVEN CLUTCH SERVICE 4. Place the clutch into Clutch Compression Tool PN
8700220. Using Compression Extensions PN PS-45909,
Driven Clutch Disassembly Press down on top of the spider assembly, compressing the
spider onto the shaft. Remove snap ring (A) and slowly
1. Remove driven clutch from the transmission input shaft. release the assembly.
Do not attempt disassembly of the driven clutch from the Press down on spider
outside snap ring. The driven clutch must be disassembled
from the helix side.
3. Remove the four torx screws that secure the cam assembly
(helix) using a T25 torx.
6.22
CLUTCH SYSTEM
6. Remove the inside spider plate (D) and spider dampener 10. Pull out the clutch roller pins (L) and rollers (M).
(E). Inspect the spider dampener (E) for wear and replaced
if needed.
D K
E
M L
7. Remove the E-clip (F), washer (G), and the clutch rollers
(H). Inspect the rollers for wear replace if worn.
H G
F
K
11. Press the shaft and bearing out of the outer sheave using a
press.
6
8. Remove the clutch assembly from the holding tool.
Remove the large outer retaining ring (I) and the inner
retaining ring (J).
Inspect Bearing
6.23
CLUTCH SYSTEM
12. Inspect the bearing for wear. Spin the bearing, if the Table 6-1:
bearing does not spin smoothly replace as needed. To
remove the bearing, simply press the bearing from the shaft. ITEM QTY PART DESCRIPTION PART #
13. Inspect the bearing for wear. Spin the bearing, if the
-- 1 Bushing Replacement Kit 2871226
bearing does not spin smoothly replace as needed. To
remove the bearing, simply press the bearing from the shaft. -- 1 Piston Pin Puller 2870386
-- 1 Instructions 9915111
Inspect Bushing
6.24
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Driven Clutch Bushing Installation EBS DRIVEN CLUTCH REASSEMBLY
1. Install puller adapter (Item 10) onto puller. 1. Press a new bearing onto the output shaft using a press.
2. Install adapter (Item 9) onto puller.
6.
assembly into sheave.
Install left hand thread nut (C) onto puller rod and hand
6
tighten against installation tool.
7. Turn clutch sheave counterclockwise, making sure bushing
is drawn straight into bore. Continue until bushing is
seated.
8. Remove nut (C) from puller rod and set aside.
9. Remove installation tool and clutch sheave from puller.
6.25
CLUTCH SYSTEM
3. Install the small and large retaining rings into the outer 5. Install the roller (A) onto the roller pin (B). (Both Sides).
sheave above the bearing.
6. Install the roller pin into the sheave assembly. (Both sides).
The flat side of the roller pin faces downward when the
shaft side is laying flat on the bench.
4. Line up the X on the moveable sheave with the X on
the stationary sheave or use the marks previously used. Put
the sheaves together.
Align Xs
7. Install the spring pins (C) to secure the roller pins. Install
until flush with sheave surface.
6.26
CLUTCH SYSTEM
8. Install the spacer washer. 12. Install the spider assembly onto the shaft with the retaining
ring on top of the spider. NOTE: Use the marks previously
Install Spacer Washer made to align the skip tooth spider, or use the X on top
of the spider and align it with the skip tooth on the shaft.
Align Marks
9. Install the spring over the shaft (arrow). 13. Place the clutch into Clutch Compression Tool PN
8700220. Using Compression Extensions PN PS-45909,
Press down on the top of the spider assembly, pushing the
spider onto the shaft.
Press Down on Spider
10. Install the clutch rollers (D) onto each side of the outside
spider. Install the washers (E) and E-clips (F) to secure the
rollers. Spin the roller, the rollers should spin freely.
11. Install the spider dampener (G) inside the outer spider and 14. Slowly compress the spider into place. If the spider appears
install the inside spider plate (H). to bind while compressing, stop and make sure the skip
tooth on the shaft and the spider are aligned. Once the
Outer Spider
D spider passes the retaining ring notch on the shaft, install
E F the retaining ring (A).
H A
6.27
CLUTCH SYSTEM
15. Install the cam assembly (helix) over the shaft. Line up the STANDARD DRIVE CLUTCH
X on the cam, X on spider, and X on the stationary
sheave or use the marks previously made before Drive Clutch Disassembly
disassembly. NOTE: If the cam assembly (helix) is
difficult to install, be sure the sheaves are aligned. To align 1. Using a permanent marker, mark the cover, spider, and
the sheaves place the clutch assembly on a flat surface with moveable and stationary sheaves for reference, as the
the cam assembly (helix) side down. Press down on the previous X's may not have been in alignment before
moveable sheave belt face with both hands and the helix disassembly.
will release. 2. Remove cover bolts evenly in a cross pattern and remove
cover plate.
Press Down to Loosen Helix 3. Inspect cover bushing (A). The outer cover bushing is
manufactured with a Teflon coating. Wear is determined
by the amount of Teflon remaining on the bushing.
16. Use a T25 torx to install the four torx screws and torque to
specification.
Inspect Shaft
=T
T25 Torx:
42-52 in. lbs. (4.75 - 5.88 Nm)
6.28
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Spider Removal 2. Inspect the Teflon coating on the moveable sheave
bushing.
1. Remove the limiter nut using the Clutch Spider Nut Socket
PN 2870338. Install clutch in holding fixture and loosen
the spider (counterclockwise) using Clutch Spider Install
Tool PN 2870341.
6.29
CLUTCH SYSTEM
4. Rubber backed buttons can and should be used in all ATV Shift Weight Inspection
clutches if the hollow roller pin is changed to a solid roller
pin. 1. If clutch is not disassembled, inspect as shown, using a
clutch holding tool to compress the moveable sheave. The
NOTE: The rubber side of the button is positioned
contact surface of the weight should be smooth and free of
toward the solid roller pin. It is recommended to
dents or gall marks. Remove shift weight bolts and
switch all buttons to the rubber version during
weights.
service (if needed).
WARNING
6.30
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Sheave / Bushing Inspection NOTE: Bushings are installed at the factory using
Loctite 609. In order to remove bushings it will be
Inspect the Teflon coating on the sheave bushings and cover
bushing. Inspect BOTH sheaves for signs of wear, grooving or necessary to apply heat evenly to the area around
cracking. Clean sheave surfaces with a 3M pad if needed. each bushing. Clean all residual Loctite from
bushing bore prior to installing new bushing.
CAUTION
6.31
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Drive Clutch Bushing Installation Drive Clutch Reassembly
1. Place main adapter on puller. NOTE: It is important that the same number and
2. Apply Loctite 609 evenly to bushing bore inside thickness of washers are reinstalled beneath the
moveable sheave. spider during assembly. The Teflon bushings are
3. Set bushing in place on sheave. self-lubricating. Do not apply oil or grease to the
4. Insert installation puller tool into center of bushing. bushings.
5. With towers pointing upward, slide sheave, bushing and
Reassemble drive clutch in the following sequence. Be sure the
tool onto puller rod. X, or the marks that were made earlier, are aligned during
6. Install nut on puller rod and hand tighten. Turn barrel to each phase of assembly.
apply additional tension if needed.
A) X, or the marks that were made earlier on cover
7. Turn sheave counterclockwise, making sure bushing is
drawn straight into bore. Continue until bushing is seated. B) X on spider, making sure spacer washers are installed
underneath spider and positioned properly in recess
8. Remove nut from puller rod and set aside.
9. Remove sheave from puller. C) X, or the marks that were made earlier under weight
10. Remove installation tool.
6.32
CLUTCH SYSTEM
8. Reinstall cover, aligning bosses on the tower and cover.
Torque cover bolts evenly to specification.
Spacer Washers
=T
Spider Torque:
200 ft. lbs. (271 Nm)
CAUTION
=T
=T
Cover Screw Torque:
Spider Limiter Nut Torque: 90 in. lbs. (10.4 Nm)
15 ft. lbs. (20 Nm)
Engine
Rotation
6.33
CLUTCH SYSTEM
STANDARD DRIVEN CLUTCH 3. Separate the clutch sheaves by pulling upward while
rotating the inner sheave.
Disassembly
1. Using special tool PN 8700220, apply and hold downward
pressure on the outer spring retainer and remove the snap
ring (A).
Inspection
1. Inspect both the inner and outer sheave surfaces. Replace
the entire clutch assembly if worn, damaged or cracked.
2. Inspect the inner sheave helix (E) and spring retainer (F)
CAUTION for signs of wear.
3. Remove the inner spring retainer (F) from the inner sheave
and inspect for signs of wear.
6.34
CLUTCH SYSTEM
4. Inspect the rollers in the stationary sheave for signs of wear. Assembly
1. Install inner spring retainer (if removed).
2. Install the inner sheave onto the outer sheave.
NOTE: Verify X marks on each side of the sheaves
are aligned upon reassembly of sheaves.
6.35
CLUTCH SYSTEM
PVT TROUBLESHOOTING
General Range Operation Guidelines
Overheating
LOW RANGE: Heavy pulling, basic operational speeds less
IMPORTANT: During routine maintenance or than 7 MPH, riding through rough terrain (swamps, mountains,
whenever PVT system overheating is evident, it's etc..), low ground speeds.
important to check the inlet and outlet ducting for
obstructions. Obstructions to air flow through the
ducts will significantly increase PVT system
operating temperatures. The ATV should be operated
in low range when pulling or plowing heavy loads, or HIGH RANGE: High ground speeds, speeds above 7 MPH.
if extended low speed operation is anticipated.
6.36
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Problem, Cause and Remedy Chart
Engine RPM below -Wrong or broken drive clutch spring. -Replace with recommended spring.
specified operating range -Install correct shift weight kit to match engine
-Drive clutch shift weight too heavy.
although engine is application.
properly tuned. -Driven clutch spring broken or installed wrong . -Replace spring; refer to proper installation location
a. Disassemble drive clutch; inspect shift weights for
-Drive clutch binding. wear and free operation.
Erratic engine operating -Belt worn unevenly - thin/burnt spots Replace belt
RPM during acceleration
or load variations. a. Replace ramp buttons.
-Driven clutch malfunction. b. Inspect movable sheave for excessive bushing
6.37
CLUTCH SYSTEM
Table 6-2: Problem, Cause and Remedy
SITUATION POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
-Abuse (continued throttle application when -Caution operator to operate machine within
vehicle is stationary, excess load) guidelines.
-Vehicle operated with park brake on. Inspect brake
Belt burnt, thin spots -Dragging brake
system.
-Instruct firm, effective use of throttle for efficient
-Slow, easy clutch engagement
engagement.
-Belt worn or separated, thin spots, loose
-Replace belt.
belt
PVT noise
-Broken or worn clutch components, cover
-Inspect and repair as necessary.
hitting clutches
-Replace belt. Refer to belt burnt troubleshooting and
Engagement -Thin spots on belt, worn belt
instruct operator.
erratic or jerks
-Drive clutch bushings stick -Inspect and repair clutches.
6.38
FINAL DRIVE
CHAPTER 7
FINAL DRIVE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
TORQUE TABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
GEARCASE FLUID / CAPACITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
FRONT DRIVE AXLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (CV) BOOT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
FRONT HUB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
PROP SHAFT - FRONT OR REAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
U-JOINT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.8
DRIVE AXLE EXPLODED VIEWS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
DRIVE SHAFTS AND PROPSHAFTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.10
FRONT GEARCASE - CENTRALIZED HILLIARD (STANDARD MODELS). . . . . . . . . . 7.11
EXPLODED VIEW (STANDARD MODELS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.11
OPERATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.12
GEARCASE REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.12
DISASSEMBLY / INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.13
REASSEMBLY / INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.17
SETTING RING GEAR BACKLASH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.18
FRONT GEARCASE DIAGNOSIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19
GEARCASE INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
7
FRONT GEARCASE - ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (DELUXE MODELS). . . . . . . . . 7.21
ADC GEARCASE EXPLODED VIEW (DELUXE MODELS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.21
OPERATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.22
ADC COIL TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.23
ADC DIFFERENTIAL HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT BLEEDING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.23
DISASSEMBLY / INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.23
ADC GEARCASE PISTON REPLACEMENT PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.27
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.29
REAR HUB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.32
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.32
DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.33
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.34
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.34
REAR DRIVE (CV) SHAFT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.35
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.35
SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.36
CV BOOT REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.37
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.38
DRIVE SHAFT AND CV JOINT HANDLING TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.39
REAR GEARCASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.39
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.39
DISASSEMBLY AND INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.39
REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.41
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.42
REAR GEARCASE EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.43
7.1
FINAL DRIVE
SPECIFICATIONS Gearcase Fluid / Capacity
Demand Drive LT
FT.LBS. Centralized Hilliard
COMPONENT NM Premium Hub Fluid
(IN.LBS.) (Standard Models)
8.97 oz. (265 ml)
F/R Steel Wheel Nuts 30 41 Centralized Hilliard Demand Drive LT
F/R Aluminum Wheel Nuts 90 122 w/ ADC Premium Hub Fluid
(Deluxe Models) 9.3 oz. (275 ml)
Front Hub Nut 70 95
Rear Hub Nut 80 109 ADC Gearcase Polaris ADC or AW ISO 10
Pump Reservoir Hydraulic Fluid
Front Gearcase Mount Bolts 30 41
AGL Synthetic or ADF
Standard Gearcase Screws 14 19 Rear Gearcase
5.0 oz. (150 ml)
Rear Gearcase Mount Bolts 30 41
Rear Gearcase Bolts 25 34 FRONT DRIVE AXLE
Lower Hub Carrier Bolts 50 68 Removal
Upper Hub Carrier Bolts 35 48
1. Set the ATV in park. Remove hub dust cap.
ADC Pump Screws (17-23) 1.9 - 2.5 2. Remove cotter pin.
ADC Cover Screws 7 - 11 9.4 - 14.9 3. Loosen the hub retaining nut.
ADC Bleed Valves (80) 9 4. Loosen - but do not remove - the wheel nuts.
5. Safely lift and support the front of the ATV.
IMPORTANT: Verify which type of wheel ATV is
equipped with (aluminum or steel) when torquing
wheel nuts. CAUTION
6. Remove wheel.
PART NUMBER TOOL DESCRIPTION 7. Remove the two brake caliper attaching bolts.
2872608 Roller Pin Removal Tool
8700226 CV Boot Clamp Pliers
2870772 1 3/4 Straight Wrench
ADC Gearcase Piston
PA-48542
Installation Tool
CAUTION
7.2
FINAL DRIVE
8. Remove hub. 10. Pull strut assembly out while pivoting front drive shaft
downward until it clears strut assembly.
9. Remove cotter pin and nut from lower A-arm ball joint.
Remove lower A-arm from ball joint. 11. Pull strut assembly out while pivoting front drive shaft
downward until it clears strut assembly.
7.3
FINAL DRIVE
Installation FRONT DRIVE SHAFT (CV) BOOT
1. Install new spring ring on drive shaft. Apply an anti-seize
Inspection
compound to splines. Align splines of drive shaft with
front gearcase and install by lightly tapping on drive shaft Check the front and rear driveshaft CV boots for any tears or
with rubber faced hammer. leaking grease. If the driveshaft boot loses all of the grease CV
joint failure will occur.
2. Install drive shaft in strut.
3. Install lower ball joint, torque nut to specification and
install new cotter pin.
=T
Ball Joint Retaining Nut Torque:
25 ft. lbs. (34.5 Nm)
Replacement
1. Remove wheel, brake caliper, and wheel hub. Refer to
FRONT DRIVE AXLE REMOVAL earlier in this
chapter for procedure.
2. Remove cotter pin and castle nut from A-arm ball joint.
=T
Front Hub Retaining Nut Torque:
70 ft. lbs. (95 Nm)
7.4
FINAL DRIVE
3. Disconnect A-arm from ball joint using a tie rod fork. 7. Remove small clamp and boot from driveshaft.
NOTE: If the ATV has been operated with a damaged
boot, the CV joint grease may be contaminated.
Inspect the grease carefully for contamination, and
clean the joint thoroughly if necessary. Front drive
axle CV boot replacement requires 3.5 oz. of grease.
4. Slide strut off end of drive shaft and tie it up out of the way 8. Before installing the new boot, remove all grease from the
of the shaft. boot area and shaft.
5. Remove clamps from rubber boot using the proper boot NOTE: It is very important to use the correct type
clamp pliers. and quantity of grease. Use only the grease
6. Remove the large end of the boot from the CV joint, slide contained in the boot kit. DO NOT use a substitute
the boot back and separate the wheel spindle and CV joint grease and DO NOT overfill or under fill the CV joint.
assembly from the axle shaft by pulling the shaft sharply 9. Slide the new clamp and boot (small end first) over the
outward, away from the CV joint. It may be necessary to splined shaft, then slide (tap) the CV joint into the splines
tap the CV joint assembly outward with a soft faced of the axle.
hammer. 10. Add grease through large end of boot.
11. Install a new boot onto the axle shaft and fill the CV joint
Retaining Ring and boot with the correct type and amount of grease.
12. While pulling out on the CV shaft, fully extend the CV joint
and slide a straight O-ring pick or a small slotted screw
7
driver between the small end of the boot and the shaft. This
will allow the air pressure to equalize in the CV boot in the
position that the joint will spend most of its life. Before you
remove your instrument, be sure the small end of the boot
is in its correct location on the axle. CARE MUST BE
TAKEN TO AVOID DAMAGE TO THE NEWLY
INSTALLED BOOT.
7.5
FINAL DRIVE
13. Install the small clamp on the boot. punch in the reliefs as shown.
Front Shaft
Assembly
1. Support bottom of hubstrut housing.
2. Start bearing in housing.
3. Press bearing into place until outer race bottoms on
2. From the back side, tap on the outer bearing race with a drift housing.
CAUTION
7.6
FINAL DRIVE
PROP SHAFT - FRONT OR REAR U-JOINT
Removal and Installation Disassembly
1. Using Roll Pin Removal Tool (PN 2872608), remove the
roll pin from prop shaft at rear of housing (front only) or CAUTION
transmission output shaft (rear only). Slide prop shaft back
and away from housing, then pull sharply forward to Always wear eye protection when working with
remove from transmission shaft. spring-tensioned components
2. For installation, reverse the removal procedure.
1. Remove internal or external snap ring from all bearing
caps.
7.7
FINAL DRIVE
3. Support U-joint in vise as shown and drive inner yoke down Assembly
to remove remaining bearing ca
1. Install new bearing caps in yoke by hand. Carefully install
U-joint cross with grease fitting properly positioned
inward toward center of shaft. Take care not to dislodge
needle bearings upon installation of cross joint. Tighten
vise to force bearing caps in.
4. Force U-joint cross to one side and lift out of inner yoke.
7.8
FINAL DRIVE
4. Install snap ring to contain bearing cap just installed.
Repeat procedure for other side.
7.9
FINAL DRIVE
DRIVE AXLE EXPLODED VIEWS
Drive Shafts and Propshafts
NOTE: Refer to your parts manual for the proper replacement parts.
Clamps
Drive Boot Replacement Kits
Clamp 3.5 oz. grease
Boot
Outer Clamp
7.10
FINAL DRIVE
FRONT GEARCASE - CENTRALIZED HILLIARD (STANDARD MODELS)
Exploded View (Standard Models)
12 13
10 11
14
15
16 17
18
16
6 19
8 1
7
9
6 20
10
5
4
2 21
22
1
7
Ref. # Description Qty Ref. # Description Qty
1 Bolt 8 12 Vent Tube 1
2 Oil Seal 1 13 Plug 1
3 Input Cover Plate Asm. 1 14 Gearcase Sub Asm. 1
4 O-Ring 1 15 Ring Gear / Clutch Housing 1
5 Retaining Ring 1 16 Output Hub Asm. 2
6 Bearing 3 17 Roll Cage Asm 1
7 Pinion Gear Asm. 1 18 Armature Plate 1
8 Pinion Bushing 1 19 Output Cover Asm 1
9 Magnetic Drain Plug 1 20 Connector Asm. 1
10 Oil Seal 2 21 Thrust Button Asm. 1
11 Plug Cap 1 22 Set Screw 1
7.11
FINAL DRIVE
Operation
Rollers
Engaging front gearcase: The AWD switch may be turned on
or off while the vehicle is moving. AWD will not enable until
the engine rpm is below 3100 RPM. Once enabled, the AWD
remains engaged while the front gearcase is moving and will not Ring Gear
disengage until the rear wheels regain traction.
CAUTION
Roll Cage Output Hubs Armature Plate Disengagement: As the front and rear wheels gain equal
traction, rotating very close to the same speed, the transmission
shaft overdrives" the front gearcase input. The rollers are
forced outward, disengaging the AWD. The vehicle is now back
to rear wheel drive until the next loss of rear wheel traction.
Gearcase Removal
1. Stop engine, place machine in Park and set parking brake.
3. Elevate the machine until the front wheels are off the
ground and support machine under footrest/frame area.
Ring Gear Magnetic Coil
CAUTION
4x4 Engagement: When the AWD switch is activated, a 12 Vdc Serious injury may result if machine tips or falls. Be
current charges the central coil, creating a magnetic field. This
magnetic field attracts an armature plate keyed to a roller cage sure machine is secure before beginning this
that contains 14 rollers and roller cam. The difference in rpm service procedure. Wear eye protection when
between the input shaft and front axles forces the rollers up the removing and installing bearings and seals.
external cam. The rollers engage, or wedge themselves
between the pinion gear and output hubs that link both front 4. Remove left wheel nuts and wheel.
axles, resulting in true all wheel drive.
7.12
FINAL DRIVE
5. Remove cotter pin, lower ball joint nut and A-arm from 8. Remove bolts securing the bottom of housing to the skid
ball joint. plate frame. Bolts and fluid drain plug are accessible
through the skid plate.
6. Pull the hub and strut assembly out and pull the drive-shaft
out of the hub. 9. Remove vent line.
10. Remove the front gearcase from left side of frame, pulling
both the remaining CV shaft and propshaft from the
gearcase. Replace the circlips on the CV shaft ends prior
to reassembly.
7. Remove the roller pin from the front prop shaft. Use the
Roller Pin Removal Tool (PN 2872608).
Remove 4 Bolts
Disassembly / Inspection
1. Drain and properly dispose of used oil. Remove any metal
particles from the drain plug magnet.
7.13
FINAL DRIVE
2. Remove bolts retaining the outer cover plate assembly. 4. Remove the armature plate and RH output hub assembly
from the outer cover plate. Inspect the bearing and contact
surfaces of the output hub for signs of wear or damage.
Replace component if found to be worn or damaged
Output Hub Assembly Armature Plate
7.14
FINAL DRIVE
6. Remove the LH output hub. Inspect the bearing and 9. Inspect roll cage (B) sliding surface. This surface must be
contact surfaces of the output hub for signs of wear or clean and free of nicks, burrs or scratches. Inspect the H-
damage. Replace component if found to be worn or springs but do not remove them from the roll cage.
damaged.
B H-Spring
8. Inspect the ring gear (C) for consistent wear patterns. The
surfaces should be free of nicks or burrs.
7
A C B
7.15
FINAL DRIVE
11. Inspect the magnetic coil (A) in the outer cover plate 13. Remove the snap ring retaining the input shaft assembly.
assembly. Inspect the backlash pad (B) for excessive wear.
A
B 14. Remove the input shaft assembly. Inspect the pinion gear
NOTE: See FRONT GEARCASE DIAGNOSIS later (C) for chipped, broken, or missing teeth. Inspect the input
in this chapter for more details on the coil. shaft bearing (D) for signs of wear. Replace the input shaft
cover O-ring prior to reassembly.
NOTE: The backlash for the centralized hilliard is set
at the factory. No adjustment is required, unless the
front cover needs to be replaced, or the back lash C
pad screw is removed. See the FRONT GEARCASE D
ASSEMBLY procedure later in this chapter for
details on backlash setting.
12. Remove the bolts retaining the input shaft cover and pinion
gear assembly.
7.16
FINAL DRIVE
Reassembly / Inspection 5. Install the LH output hub (A) into the gearcase housing.
The output hub should spin freely.
1. Replace all O-rings, seals, and worn components.
A
6. Install the RH output hub (B) into the output cover. The
2. Press the pinion shaft seal into the pinion cover, until the output hub should spin freely.
seal is flush with the sealing surface.
7. Install the rollers and roll cage into the ring gear. Insert the
rollers as the roll cage is installed.
=T
Input Cover Bolt Torque
14 ft. lbs. (19 Nm)
7.17
FINAL DRIVE
8. Install the ring gear and roll cage assembly into the 11. Torque the cover plate bolts to specification.
gearcase housing.
9. Install the armature plate on top of the roll cage / ring gear
assembly. Be sure that the armature plate tabs are fully
engaged into the roll cage assembly.
=T
Output Cover Bolt Torque
14 ft. lbs. (19 Nm)
12. Lay the gearcase on the side with the output cover facing up.
10. Install the cover plate assembly with new o-ring onto the Setting Ring Gear Backlash
main gearcase.
NOTE: Ring gear backlash is set at the factory. No
NOTE: Verify the square O-ring is placed flat on the
adjustment is required, unless the front cover is
cover surface. If the O-ring is twisted fluid leakage
replaced or the back lash pad screw is removed.
may occur.
1. The backlash screw has locking agent that holds it into
place. Use a heat gun to lightly heat up the locking agent
on the screw.
7.18
FINAL DRIVE
2. Using a 3/32 hex wrench, turn the back-lash screw out 3-4 NOTE: To test the gearcase coil resistance, use the
turns. Re-apply Loctite 262 onto the bottom screw coil harness. The gearcase coil should measure
threads. between 22.8 ohms and 25.2 ohms.
7.19
FINAL DRIVE
4. Check to make sure the coil is seated in the U-shaped insert Gearcase Installation
that is pressed into the gearcase cover. The top of the coil
should be seated below the U-shaped insert. The U-shaped 1. To install gearcase, reverse removal procedures. Use new
insert controls the pole gap. If the top of the coil is above roll pin in front prop shaft.
the surface of the U-shaped insert it raises the armature 2. Torque mounting bolts in skid plate to 30 ft.lbs. (41 Nm).
plate, thereby increasing pole gap. If the pole gap
increases the coil will not be strong enough to engage the 30ft.lbs. (41 Nm)
AWD system. If this is the cause order a new Cover Plate
Assembly.
Coil
U-Shaped Insert
=T
Gearcase Mounting Bolt Torque:
5. Inspect the rollers for nicks, scratches, and flat spots. Also 30ft.lbs. (41 Nm)
inspect the roll cage for cracks and ensure the rollers are
able to slide up and down and in and out freely within the
roll cage sliding surfaces.
New Roll Pin
Rollers
7.20
FINAL DRIVE
FRONT GEARCASE - ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (DELUXE MODELS)
ADC Gearcase Exploded View (Deluxe Models)
7.21
FINAL DRIVE
Operation ADC Engagement: When the AWD switch is activated, a 12
Vdc current is present at the input shaft coil (1). Operation is
Engaging Front Gearcase: Active Descent Control (ADC) is controlled by the ECU grounding and ungrounding the coil. The
controlled by the ECU and will not enable until the following coils magnetic field attracts a splined armature plate (2) on the
conditions are met: pinion (input) shaft (4). The energized splined armature plate
attracts the unsplined eccentric cam (3), which begins to turn
Vehicle speed is below 15 Mph (24Kph) with the input shaft. The eccentric cam drives a hydraulic
piston/pump assembly (5). The pressure created by the pump
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is at idle position assembly forces hydraulic fluid through passages to the piston
assemblies (6) located in each case half. Hydraulic pressure
The AWD switch is switched to AWD forces the piston assemblies inward to compress the splined
clutch packs (7) forming a dynamic coupling to each front drive
Once the conditions are met for engagement, ADC remains axle, resulting in true all-wheel EBS operation upon
engaged as long as the conditions are met. deceleration.
With the AWD switch off, the vehicle drives only the rear Disengagement: Current to the ADC coil is turned off by the
wheels (2 wheel drive). When the AWD switch is ON the ECU anytime the following conditions are met:
magnetic coils are active, the AWD coil indexes the clutch
mechanism so that both front axles will engage when there is a Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) moves off idle position
loss of rear wheel traction. In addition to the rear wheel engine
braking, the ADC coil provides front wheel engine braking at The AWD switch is switched to OFF
speeds less than 15 Mph (24Kph) with the TPS at idle position.
Vehicle speed is above 15 Mph (24Kph)
Hydraulic pressure stops and the pistons release, disengaging
the ADC function. The vehicle returns to rear wheel drive until
the next deceleration.
2
3
4
7
7
7.22
FINAL DRIVE
ADC Coil Testing Disassembly / Inspection
Refer to the following tests in Chapter 10: NOTE: See Gearcase Removal on page 7.12.
1. Drain and properly dispose of used oil. Remove any metal
See ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (ADC) COIL on
page 10.15. particles from the drain plug magnet.
2. Remove the piston pump assembly from the gearcase.
See ALL WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) COIL on page 10.15.
=T
Bleeder Valve Torque:
80 in. lbs. (9 Nm)
7.23
FINAL DRIVE
4. Remove the outer cover plate assembly. Remove and 6. Remove the armature plate. Inspect the armature plate for
inspect the cover o-ring (1). Inspect thrust bearing (2) for wear, distortion or other damage. Replace component as
wear. Replace items as required. required.
NOTE: Thrust bearing (2) located between the two 7. Remove the spacer. Inspect for signs of wear or damage.
output assemblies is pressed into the clutch pack Replace component as required.
and is not removable. NOTE: locating pins (arrow) are for spacer
5. Remove the output clutch assemblies. Inspect the bearings, installation. Note for reassembly.
contact surfaces and splines of the output clutch for signs
of wear or damage. Visually inspect the clutch plate area.
If plates are steel-on-steel, or if the friction material is worn,
the assembly should be replaced.
7.24
FINAL DRIVE
8. Remove the ring gear (1) and spacer (2). 12. Inspect roll cage sliding surface (2). This surface must be
clean and free of nicks, burrs or scratches. Remove and
inspect the H-springs (4). Replace any components as
required.
1 2 4
2
1 3 2
7.25
FINAL DRIVE
14. Inspect the magnetic coil (1) in the outer cover plate 16. Inspect the magnetic coil (1) and bushing in the input cover
assembly. Inspect the backlash pad (2) for excessive wear. plate assembly. Replace the input cover seal.
1 2
NOTE: See FRONT GEARCASE DIAGNOSIS in this 17. Remove the splined armature plate (1).
chapter.
NOTE: Ring gear backlash (2) is set at the factory.
No adjustment is required, unless the front cover is
replaced or the back lash pad screw is removed.
See the FRONT GEARCASE ASSEMBLY in this
chapter for details on backlash setting. 1
15. Remove the bolts retaining the input shaft cover and pinion
gear assembly.
18. Remove the eccentric cam assembly. Inspect the cam (1)
and bushing (2) for wear or damage. Replace component
as required.
7.26
FINAL DRIVE
19. Remove the snap ring retaining the input shaft assembly. ADC Gearcase Piston Replacement
Procedure
CAUTION
AIR
20. Remove the input shaft assembly. Inspect the pinion gear
(1) for chipped, broken, or missing teeth. Inspect the input
shaft bearing (2) for signs of wear. Replace the input shaft
cover O-ring (3) prior to reassembly.
1 3
ADC Piston Tool
2 PA-48542
3. Remove and discard the inner and outer o-rings from the
piston assembly.
NOTE: Never re-use o-rings. Always replace with
new.
7.27
FINAL DRIVE
4. Coat new piston and o-rings with a moderate amount of 6. Place ADC Piston Tool PA-48542 on top of the piston and
white lithium grease or assembly lube. Coat the edges of the verify alignment of the sight hole (circled) and piston mark
piston cavities. Install the inner and outer piston o-rings. with the casting marks. Support the case and press the
piston down evenly. The piston is fully seated and located
in the pin bosses when the piston surface is just below the
Outer
cavity edge.
Inner
5. Place the piston in the piston cavity, aligning the pins with
the pin bosses. Using the casting and piston marks as a Tool PA-48542
guide as shown will aid pin alignment.
7.28
FINAL DRIVE
Assembly 5. Install the eccentric cam assembly (1).
2
1
7
7. Install the input shaft cover assembly, bolts and bracket.
Torque to specification.
=T
Input Cover Bolt Torque:
7-11 ft. lbs. (9.4-14.9 Nm)
7.29
FINAL DRIVE
8. Install a new seal (1) in the outer cover plate assembly. 10. Install the clutch pack (1), spacer (2) and ring gear (3).
Install a new o-ring on the backlash pad (2) stem . NOTE: Align locating pins / holes for installation.
1 2
3
2
1
NOTE: Ring gear backlash (2) is set at the factory. 11. Install the spacer.
No adjustment is required, unless the front cover is
NOTE: Align locating pins / holes for installation
replaced or the back lash pad screw is removed.
(arrow).
9. Install the roll cage and rollers into the ring gear. Insert the
rollers as the roll cage is installed.
12. Install the armature plate. Verify the armature plate tabs
align with tab recesses in the roll cage.
7.30
FINAL DRIVE
13. Install new cover o-ring (1) on the cover plate assembly 15. Place cover assembly on Install bolts (arrows) retaining the
and a new passage o-ring (2) on the gear case. outer cover plate assembly and torque to specification.
=T
Pump Assembly Screw Torque:
17-23 in. lbs. (1.9-2.5 Nm)
7.31
FINAL DRIVE
REAR HUB 8. Remove hub nut, domed washer and flat washer.
Removal
1. Place the ATV in Park and lock the parking brake.
Remove rear hub cap.
9. Remove hub.
B
C
7.32
FINAL DRIVE
11. Remove both lower control arm bolts. 2. From the back side, tap on the outer bearing race with a drift
punch in the reliefs as shown or press out using a hydraulic
press.
7.33
FINAL DRIVE
Assembly 3. Press bearing into place until outer race bottoms on
housing.
1. Support bottom of bearing carrier housing.
Installation
1. Insert bearing carrier on drive shaft.
2. Align bottom of carrier housing and lower control arm.
Grease and slide lower control arm bushings into place,
securing corner housing.
3. Install and torque both lower control arm bolts.
=T
Upper Control Arm Bolt Torque:
35 ft. lbs. (48 Nm)
7.34
FINAL DRIVE
REAR DRIVE (CV) SHAFT
=T
Removal
Lower Control Arm Bolt Torque:
50 ft. lbs. (68 Nm) 1. Remove rear hub, see REAR HUB REMOVAL.
2. Remove upper carrier bolt. Tip hub outward and remove
4. Lift bearing carrier until top aligns with upper control arm. shaft from carrier.
Install and torque upper control arm bolt and torque to
specification.
5. Pull drive shaft outward and install hub onto driveshaft
splines.
6. Install cone washers with domed side facing outward.
7. Install retainer nut, wheel and wheel nuts.
8. Remove jackstand and torque axle nut and wheel nuts to
specification.
7
=T
Wheel Nut Torque:
See Torque Table on page 7.2.
=T
Hub Nut Torque:
80 ft. lbs. (109 Nm) Lock Ring
7.35
FINAL DRIVE
Service 3. Open the snap ring using a snap ring pliers or small needle
nose pliers. Tap CV housing off shaft with a soft faced
1. Remove clamps from rubber boot(s) using the CV Boot hammer while holding snap ring open.
Clamp Pliers (PN 8700226) (A).
Spread ends of snap ring to
remove joint from shaft
Snap Ring
7.36
FINAL DRIVE
5. Refit CV joint on interconnecting shaft by tapping with a CV Boot Replacement
plastic hammer on the joint housing. Take care not to
damage threads on the outboard CV joint. The joint is fully 1. Remove CV joint from end of shaft.
assembled when the snap ring is located in the groove on 2. Remove boot from shaft.
the interconnecting shaft. NOTE: When replacing a damaged boot, check the
grease for contamination by rubbing it between two
Tap joint onto shaft
fingers. A gritty feeling indicates contamination. If
the grease is not contaminated, the boot can be
replaced without cleaning the CV joint. Use the
recommended amount of grease for boot
replacement only (see below). Proceed to Boot
Installation.
3. Thoroughly clean and dry the CV joint and inspect ball
tracks and cages for wear, cracks or other damage.
NOTE: Shiny areas in ball tracks and on the cage
spheres are normal. Do not replace CV joints
because parts have polished surfaces. Replace CV
joint only if components are cracked, broken, worn
or otherwise unserviceable.
6. Install and tighten large boot clamp with boot clamp pliers.
7. Remove excess grease from the CV joint's external surfaces
and position joint boot over housing, making sure boot is
seated in groove. Position clamp over boot end and make
sure clamp tabs are located in slots. NOTE: Before
tightening boot clamp on inboard joint, make sure any air
pressure which may have built up in joint boot has been
released. The air should be released after the plunging joint
has been centered properly. Tighten boot clamp using boot
7
clamp pliers.
7.37
FINAL DRIVE
8. While pulling out on the CV shaft, fully extend the CV joint INSTALLATION
and slide a straight O-ring pick or a small slotted screw
driver between the small end of the boot and the shaft. This 1. Slide shaft assembly into bearing carrier hub.
will allow the air pressure to equalize in the CV boot in the
position that the joint will spend most of its life. Before you
remove your instrument, be sure the small end of the boot
is in its correct location on the axle.
Joint Capacity -
50 grams Joint Capacity - 50
grams
Boot Capacity -
30 Grams Boot Capacity - 50
grams =T
Outboard - 80g Total Inboard - 100g Total Upper Hub Carrier Bolt Torque:
35 ft. lbs. (48 Nm)
Inboard Joint - 50g if boot is replaced only. Another 50g (100 Hub Nut Torque:
total) if joint is cleaned. 80 ft. lbs. (109 Nm)
7.38
FINAL DRIVE
6. Install rear wheel and torque wheel nuts to specification. REAR GEARCASE
80 ft.lbs. (109 Nm) Removal
1. Place ATV on a level surface and place transmission in
PARK.
2. Loosen both rear wheel nuts.
3. Loosen both rear center hub nuts.
4. Lift and safely support rear of ATV so that the rear wheels
are off the ground.
5. Remove the roll pin from the rear transmission yoke and
pull vent line off the gearcase.
6. Remove both rear wheels and center hub nuts.
NOTE: Hub removal is not required to remove CV
shafts.
7. Remove both upper hub carrier bolts. Tilt hubs outward and
remove both CV shafts.
Refer to Page 7.2 for Wheel Nut Torque. 8. Remove the upper and lower bolts from the gearcase
mounts.
7. Grease all fittings thoroughly with Premium U-Joint 9. Pull gearcase out the rear of the vehicle. Some prying and
Lubricant (PN 2871551). tapping with a soft-face hammer may be required. Use care
not to damage other components.
Drive Shaft and CV Joint Handling Tips
Disassembly and Inspection
Care should be exercised during driveshaft removal or when
servicing CV joints. Driveshaft components are precision parts. 1. Drain and properly dispose of used oil.
Cleanliness and following these instructions is very important to 2. Remove the gearcase housing cover bolts and the gearcase
ensure proper shaft function and a normal service life. housing cover.
The complete driveshaft and joint should be handled by 7
getting hold of the interconnecting shaft to avoid
disassembly or potential damage to the driveshaft
joints.
Over-angling of joints beyond their capacity could
result in boot or joint damage.
Make sure surface-ground areas and splines of shaft are
protected during handling to avoid damage.
Do not allow boots to come into contact with sharp
edges or hot engine and exhaust components.
The driveshaft is not to be used as a lever arm to
position other suspension components.
Never use a hammer or sharp tools to remove or to
install boot clamps.
Be sure joints are thoroughly clean and that the proper
amount and type of grease is used to refill when joint
boots are replaced and when joints are cleaned. Refer
to text for grease capacity of CV joints and CV joint
boots.
7.39
FINAL DRIVE
3. Remove the shim, thrust button, and thrust button shim 5. Inspect the ring gear for abnormal wear, broken, or chipped
from the gearcase. teeth. Spin the bearing to check the ball bearings for
smoothness. Replace the bearing if needed.
6. Remove the input shaft cover and the pinion shaft from the
gearcase housing. See next page.
Thrust Button
Shims
7. Inspect the ring gear for abnormal wear, broken, or chipped
teeth. Spin the bearing to check the ball bearings for
smoothness. Replace the bearing if needed.
7.40
FINAL DRIVE
Reassembly
=T
1. Inspect the pinion shaft bushing for wear.
Input Cover Bolt Torque:
25 ft.lbs. (34 Nm)
3. Install the pinion shaft into the gearcase housing. Install the
pinion shaft cover and torque the cover bolts to
specification.
=T
Cover Bolt Torque:
25 ft.lbs. (34 Nm)
7.41
FINAL DRIVE
6. Install the drain plug and fill plug. Replace the drain plug 4. Re-install CV shafts, hubs, carrier bolts, etc. and torque to
washers to ensure proper sealing after filling. specifications.
=T
Lower Control Arm Bolt Torque:
50 ft. lbs. (68 Nm)
=T
Upper Control Arm Bolt Torque:
Fill Plug 35 ft. lbs. (48 Nm)
Drain Plug
=T
Hub Nut Torque:
=T 80 ft. lbs. (109 Nm)
=T
Gearcase Mounting Bolts
30 ft.lbs. (41 Nm)
7.42
FINAL DRIVE
Rear Gearcase Exploded View
7.43
FINAL DRIVE
NOTES
7.44
TRANSMISSION
CHAPTER 8
TRANSMISSION
SPORTSMAN. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3-8.18
SPORTSMAN X2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19-8.38
8.1
TRANSMISSION
NOTES
8.2
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
CHAPTER 8
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION EXPLODED VIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
SPORTSMAN 700/800 EFI TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
SPECIFICIATONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
LUBRICANT / CAPACITY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
TRANSMISSION SERVICE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
TRANSMISSION REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
DISASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12
TRANSMISSION INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.18
TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.18
8.3
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION EXPLODED VIEW
Sportsman Transmission
8.4
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
Transmission Exploded View Table
8.5
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
SPECIFICIATONS TRANSMISSION SERVICE
Torque Specifications Transmission Removal
Table 8-1: Torque Specifications 1. Disconnect linkage rod from gear selector handle.
2. Remove two bolts attaching gear selector mount to machine
FT.LBS.
frame.
COMPONENT NM 3. Lift gear selector out of mounting bracket and away from
(IN.LBS.)
frame.
Transmission Case Bolts 27-34 37-46 NOTE: TRANSMISSION ILLUSTRATIONS DEPICTED
Oil Deflector Screws (16-30) 2-3.3 WITH PARK LOCK. PARK LOCK IS REMOVED FOR
2007.
Shift Cover Bolt 6-12 8-16
Bell Crank Nut 12-18 16-24 4. Remove seat, rear rack, rear cab, air box, exhaust system,
and right footwell (as required for access).
Trans. Drain/Fill Plug 14 19 5. Disconnect transmission vent line.
Trans. Mounting Bolts 25 34.5 6. Drain transmission lubricant.
7. Disconnect shift linkage rod end from transmission
Snorkel Lock Screw 8-12 11-16
bellcrank.
NOTE: TRANSMISSION ILLUSTRATIONS DEPICTED Linkage Rod
WITH PARK LOCK. PARK LOCK IS REMOVED FOR
2007.
Lubricant / Capacity
Use only Polaris recommended products if possible.
=T
Fill Plug Torque: 14 ft.lbs. (19 Nm)
8.6
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
11. Use the Roll Pin Removal Tool (PN 2872608) to remove Disassembly
the roll pins from the front prop shaft and the rear prop shaft.
Remove the front propshaft. 1. Place the bellcrank in neutral position.
Shift Shaft
Cover
2. Remove the nut, and washer that secure the bell crank.
12. To remove the rear propshaft, loosen or remove the bolts Remove the bellcrank.
that secure the rear gearcase. Move the rear gearcase back
3. Remove the e-clip and then remove the transmission switch
just enough to slide the rear propshaft from the transmission
(A).
shaft.
8.7
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
4. Remove the five bolts that secure the cover. Remove the NOTE: It may be helpful to place a mark just above
detent spring (B). the keyed spline. Note the raised edge on the detent
gear for reassembly.
5. Mark the detent gear (C) with a white pen. Remove the
detent gear from the case.
8. Note the timing marks on the shift gears. Remove the shift
gears from the case.
8.8
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
9. Remove the upper gear cluster and shift forks. You may 12. Remove the bearing from the reverse shaft using a puller.
need to move the assembly back and forth to aid in removal.
13. Remove the park lock engagement dog. Remove the wave
10. Set the upper gear cluster on a flat surface and inspect the spring and reverse engagement dog.
components.
Engagement Dogs
8
14. Remove the bearing from the input shaft with a puller.
11. Remove the shift forks from the assembly. Note the correct
position of each fork.
8.9
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
15. Remove the snap ring and washer from the reverse shaft. 19. Use a press to remove the gear from the shaft.
16. Remove low gear (33T) and the needle bearing. 20. Make note of the direction of the gear and hub location.
17. Remove the reverse gear shaft. 21. Remove the gear, split bearing, and washer from the reverse
shaft.
8.10
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
22. Slide off the shift dogs and wave springs. 25. Remove the pinion shaft retainer plate and the pinion shaft.
23. Remove the snap ring, washer, gear, and split bearing. 26. Remove the front housing cover screws.
27. Remove the front housing cover, shim, thrust button, and
24. Remove bearing and the helical gear. thrust button shim. 8
8.11
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
28. Remove the shafts as an assembly. Assembly
1. Reinstall the chain onto the front output shaft and rear
output shaft.
29. Remove the silent chain from the assembly for shaft
inspection.
2. Install front and rear output shafts into the case.
8.12
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
4. Reinstall the thrust button shim, thrust button, and other 8. Apply Loctite 262 (Red) (PN 2871951) to screw threads
shims into the cover. Reinstall cover and torque bolts in a and torque screws to specification.
criss-cross pattern in 3 steps to specification.
NOTE: Verify case locating pins (knock pipes) are in
place.
=T
Pinion Retainer Plate Bolt Torque:
6-12 ft.lbs. (8-16 Nm)
=T
9. Install the a new needle bearing, the 24T reverse sprocket,
Cover Bolt Torque: washer, and a new snap ring. Install the shift dogs and wave
27-34 ft.lbs. (36.5-46 Nm)
Torque in Sequence spring. Install the washer, a new needle bearing and the
high gear. Install the press fit gear and ball bearing.
5. Install new front and rear output shaft seals. Apply grease
to the seal lips. Cover the splines of the shaft to protect the
seal lips during installation.
6. Install pinion shaft with bearing.
7. Install retainer plate with flat side toward bearing.
8.13
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
10. Slide the reverse shaft assembly through the silent chain. 14. As the engagement dogs are installed onto the shaft, place
the wave springs into the spring groove. Keep the spring
in place while the fork is being installed on the shaft and
while placing the shafts into the case.
11. Install a new needle bearing, the low gear, the thrustwasher
and the snap ring. A new snap ring is recommended.
12. Install the engagement dogs, wave springs, and bearing.
NOTE: Use caution when installing the fork, as the
spring can easily fall out.
13. Install the ball bearing onto the end of the input shaft.
8.14
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
16. Position the shift forks up and so the the pins point toward 19. Lift the shift rail slightly and rotate the rail/fork assembly
the 9 o'clock position, before installing the shift drum so it meshes with the tracks on the shiftdrum. Be sure the
assembly. wave springs are properly in place and that the shift rail is
seated into the pocket on the backside of the case.
20. Install the helical gear and bearing onto the pinion shaft.
21. Clean the mating surfaces of the case and cover. Apply
Crankcase Sealant (PN 2871557) to the mating surfaces.
Be sure the locating pins (knock pipes) are in place.
Reinstall cover, LH mounting bracket and torque bolts in a
criss-cross pattern in 3 steps to specification.
17. Replace and grease the O-rings on the shift drum before
installation.
=T
Cover Bolt Torque:
27-34 ft.lbs. (36.5-46 Nm)
22. Grease the seal lips of the input shaft seal. Apply
electricians tape or somehow cover the splines of the shaft
to protect the seal lips during installation. Install new input 8
shaft seal.
18. Install the shift drum into the case.
23. Install drain plug with a new sealing washer. Torque drain
plug to specification.
8.15
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
24. Place a small amount of grease (PN 2871551) into the 27. Apply Crankcase Sealant (PN 2871557) onto the cover and
pocket before installing the sector gear. Install the shift gear case mating surfaces. Install the cover and hand tighten all
(16T) on the shift drum shaft. Install the sector gear in the of the bolts.
bushing pocket on the left side. Aligning the timing marks
on the gears.
NOTE: Note the location of the skip tooth on the
splines. Apply a light coating of grease on the gear
teeth.
25. Install the shift shaft and the detent star. Note the keyed
spline on the end of the shaft.
28. Tighten bottom left corner bolt first. This helps to align the
cover and shafts to ensure smoother and precise shifting.
Torque the bolt to specification.
26. Install the detent pawl and spring. Install a new o-ring onto
the shift shaft after the detent pawl is assembled to the shaft.
Place a small amount of grease on the small o-ring on the
shift shaft and on the detent star. Grease the o-ring on the
end of the shift drum.
Tighten First
=T
Cover Bolt Torque:
6-12 ft.lbs. (12-16 Nm)
8.16
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
30. Install a new bellcrank onto the shift shaft. Note the keyed Transmission Installation
spline on the bellcrank and shaft. Install the washer and nut.
Torque the bellcrank nut to specification. 1. Install transmission from right side of vehicle.
2. Align output shafts to propshaft yokes and roll pin holes.
3. Slide output shafts into propshaft yokes and insert roll pins.
4. Position transmission in frame.
5. Loosely install left side and rear mounting brackets.
6. Loosely install lower right bracket bolt.
7. Loosely install front mounting bolts.
8. Install PVT back cover, bolts and driven clutch and torque
to specfication.
IMPORTANT: Align clutches as outlined in Chapter 6
9. Tighten mounting fasteners in order A-F as shown.
A D
=T C
31. Install the shift switch. Install the retaining clip. Hook up
the switch harness and reconnect the lockout plunger
B
spring.
8
=T
Transmission Mounting Bolt Torque:
25 ft.lbs. (34.5 Nm)
8.17
SPORTSMAN TRANSMISSION
Troubleshooting
Check the following items when shifting difficulty is
encountered.
Idle speed adjustment
PVT alignment
Transmission oil type/quality
Transmission torque stop adjustment (where applicable)
Engine torque stop adjustment (where applicable)
Drive belt deflection
Loose fasteners on rod ends
Loose fasteners on selector box
Worn rod ends, clevis pins, or pivot arm bushings
Linkage rod adjustment and rod end positioning
Shift selector rail travel
*Worn, broken or damaged internal transmission
components
NOTE: To determine if shifting difficulty or problem
is caused by an internal transmission problem,
isolate the transmission by disconnecting linkage
rod from transmission bellcrank. Manually select
each gear range at the transmission bellcrank, and
test ride vehicle. If it functions properly, the problem
is outside the transmission. If transmission problem
remains, disassemble transmission and inspect all
gear dogs for wear (rounding), damage. Inspect all
bearings, circlips, thrust washers and shafts for
wear.
8.18
Sportsman X2 Transmission
CHAPTER 8
Sportsman X2 Transmission
TRANSMISSION EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
MOUNTING EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.21
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
SPECIAL TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
LUBRICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
TRANSMISSION SERVICE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
GEAR SELECTOR REMOVAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
TRANSMISSION REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
TRANSMISSION INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.24
TROUBLESHOOTING CHECKLIST. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.26
TRANSMISSION DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.26
TRANSMISSION ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.31
TRANSMISSION FRONT OUTPUT SHAFT BACKLASH PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . 8.32
8.19
Sportsman X2 Transmission
TRANSMISSION EXPLODED VIEWS
X2 Transmission Exploded View
262 = THREAD LOCKING AGENT FOR ALL FT. LBS. FASTENERS
8.20
Sportsman X2 Transmission
262
242
262
262
262
262
8.21
Sportsman X2 Transmission
X2 Mounting Exploded View
x1
x1
x2
x4
x4
x1
x2
x3
8.22
Sportsman X2 Transmission
SPECIFICATIONS TRANSMISSION SERVICE
Torque Specifications Gear Selector Removal
1. Disconnect linkage rod from gear selector handle.
COMPONENT FT. LBS. NM 2. Remove two bolts attaching gear selector mount to machine
(IN.LBS.) frame.
Transmission Case Bolts 25-30 36-43 3. Lift gear selector out of mounting bracket and away from
frame.
Bell Crank Nut 12-18 17-26
Transmission Fill/Drain Plug 20-25 29-36 Transmission Removal
Trans. Mounting Bolts 40 57 1. Place vehicle in park. Raise and securely support rear of
Gear Sector Cover 8-12 11-17 ATV at the frame. Remove both rear wheels.
2. Drain transmission lubricant (if required).
Oil Deflector Screws (20-30) 2-3.6
3. Remove seat, both side panels, both rear cab quarter panels
Snorkel Torx Screw 8-12 11-17 and both footwells. See Chapter 5.
Bearing Cover 8-12 11-17 4. Disconnect the differential, speed sensor and gear selection
switch connectors from the transmission.
Carrier Cover 23-27 33-39 5. Disconnect transmission vent line (A).
Shift Fort Retainer Screws 8-12 11-17
Park Plate 8-12 11-17
Differential Solenoid 23-27 33-39
Speed Sensor 8-12 11-17
A
Special Tools
TOOL
PART NUMBER
DESCRIPTION
2871695 (Part of 2871702 Kit) Backlash Setting Tool
Rear Output Seal
2871698 (Part of 2871702 Kit)
Driver 6. Disconnect shift linkage rod end (B) from transmission 8
bellcrank (C).
Rear Driveshaft Seal
2871699 (Part of 2871702 Kit)
Guide
Bearing Seal Driver B
2871282
(50 mm) C
Lubrication
Specified Lubricant
Polaris AGL Fluid
Gearcase Capacity
Approx. 32 oz. (948ml)
7. Remove PVT outer cover, drive and driven clutches, and
Refer to Chapter 2 for transmission lubricant service. the inner PVT cover. (refer to Chapter 6).
8.23
Sportsman X2 Transmission
8. Remove both rear drive shafts. Brake caliper removal is 14. Remove the middle transmission support bracket (K)
required. Do not let calipers hang by the brake line. (See completely from the ATV.
Chapters 7 and 9)
9. Remove both upper shock absorber mounting bolts and
swing shocks away from the transmission. K
10. Remove the torsion bar mountings from the control arms.
11. Remove all fasteners (X) attaching the torsion mount, and
completely remove the mount (Z) from the ATV.
X
X
X
12. Remove both upper control arms (I). Refer to Chapter 7 for
more details.
I 16. Lift and remove transmission out right side of frame while
pulling the output shaft from the propshaft yoke.
13. Remove all lower transmission mounting fasteners (J) from
each side.
8.24
Sportsman X2 Transmission
Transmission Installation 6. Reconnect the torsion bar to both lower control arms.
Torque to specification.
1. Apply Polaris Premium All Season Grease (PN 2871423)
to splines of front output shaft ,install new Oring in prop
shaft. =T
2. With the help of an assistant, rotate transmission into place
from the right side of the frame, aligning the forward Lower Torsion Bar Bolt Torque: 17 ft.lbs. (24 Nm)
transmission bracket into the rear engine mounting holes
7. Install both upper shock absorber mounts and torque to
while ensuring that the output shaft and propshaft align and
specification.
slide together.
3. Loosely install lower transmission mounting fasteners and
forward engine mounting nuts. =T
Shock Bolt Torque: 30 ft.lbs. (43 Nm)
=T 8
Upper Carrier Bolt Torque: 50 ft.lbs. (71 Nm)
=T
Transmission Bracket Bolt Torque:
Lower - 40 ft.lbs. (57Nm)
Upper Rear / Middle Bolts - 17 ft.lbs. (24 Nm)
8.25
Sportsman X2 Transmission
9. Install the rear hubs, rear brake disc and brake caliper. Refer 16. Install the rear wheel nuts and torque to specification.
to Chapters 5 and 9 for procedures and torque
specifications.
10. Install PVT system. Refer to Chapter 6 PVT section for Rear Wheel Nut Torque
procedures and torque specifications.
Refer to Chapter 2
11. Once the PVT system is installed. Tighten all remaining
transmission mounting bolts to specification. See page 8.2
for transmission bolt placement. 17. With the ATV on level ground, add Polaris AGL Gearcase
Lubricant to the proper level. See Chapter 2 for proper fill
procedures and Torque Specifications.
=T
Polaris AGL Gearcase Lubricant
Transmission Mount Bolt Torque:
40 ft.lbs. (57Nm) (PN 2873602) (12 oz.)
(PN 2873603) (Gallon)
12. Install transmission vent line. Be sure vent line is not kinked
or pinched.
13. Install seat, both side panels, both rear cab quarter panels Troubleshooting Checklist
and both footwells. See Chapter 5.
14. Reconnect the differential, speed sensor and gear selection Check the following items when shifting difficulty is
switch connectors to the transmission. encountered.
15. Reconnect the shift rod. Torque to standard specification. Idle speed adjustment
Transmission oil type/quality
Drive belt deflection
*Worn, broken or damaged internal transmission
components
8.26
Sportsman X2 Transmission
Transmission Disassembly 6. Remove the compression spring (7).
3 4
2
1
7
7. Remove the detent star (8). Note how the detent star fits
onto the splined shaft and the raised edge facing outward
for reassembly.
8. Remove the lockout disc (9). Note the raised edge facing
outward for reassembly.
9. Remove the shift shaft (10) and the shift gears (11,12).
NOTE: Note the timing marks on the shift gears (12,13)
5. Remove the sector cover bolts (5) and remove the sector for reassembly.
cover (6). Removal can be aided by using your thumbs to
press down on the shafts and pulling up the cover with your 12
fingers. 13
7
11
5 6
10
9 8
8
8.27
Sportsman X2 Transmission
10. Remove all cover bolts. Using suitable pry tools, remove 12. Remove the cam chain tensioner spring (14). Slide the cam
the cover using the designated pry points. Tap cover with chain tensioner shoe (15), pins (16), and cam chain
soft face hammer to remove. The pry points are indicated tensioner cam (17) from the assembly.
by the white arrows in the photo below.
Pry points
17
16 16
14 15
18
19
17
14. Remove the T20 screws that secure the oil deflector (20)
with a T20 hex socket or driver.
8.28
Sportsman X2 Transmission
15. Remove the T27 screws that secure the output gear (21)
with a T27 hex socket or driver.
21
22
Reverse
Shaft
Needle
Bearing (2)
33T Gear (3)
Washer
Retaining Ring
17. Remove the output gear (21) and gear cluster assembly
from the gearcase by pulling both assemblies straight up. Engagement Bearing 8
Place the gear cluster assembly on a clean surface for Dog (1)
inspection. Input Shaft
Bearing
Bearing
21
18. Remove the bearing from the reverse shaft using a bearing
puller. Slide the engagement dog (1) off of the reverse shaft.
19. Remove the retaining ring and washer from the reverse
shaft.
20. Remove the bearing from the input shaft using a bearing
puller.
21. Remove the 33T gear (3) and needle bearing (2) from the
reverse shaft.
8.29
Sportsman X2 Transmission
22. The reverse shaft should slide out of the silent chain (4) to 26. To disassemble the shift fork rail remove the snap ring (10)
separate the assembly. from the end of the shift rail on either side.
10
4
10
CAUTION
23. Remove the rest of the bearings from the shafts. Use caution when disassembling the shift rail. The
24. Remove the engagement dog (5) from the reverse shaft. compressed springs on the shift rail may pop off causing
REVERSE SHAFT eye or face injury.
5
9
8
6 7
28. Mark the snorkel tube and case with a white pen or marker.
Towards Inside This is used to ease reassembly of the gearcase.
of Case
25. Remove the retaining ring (6) and then washer (7), gear (8),
and split bearing (9) from the reverse shaft.
8.30
Sportsman X2 Transmission
29. Use a 2 3/8 wrench to loosen and remove the front drive 30. If needed, remove the seal from the front of the snorkel
shaft snorkel tube (11). tube. Remove the snap ring (12).
12
11
31. Remove the second snap ring (13) and spacer (14) from the
Front Drive Snorkel Assembly
snorkel shaft.
NOTE: Shim may or may not be present. Depending on
input shaft tolerance.
13
14
A. O-ring
B. Seal
C. Retaining Ring
D. Retaining Ring
E. Spacer
J
F. Ball Bearing
G. Snorkel tube
H. Retaining Ring
I. Ball Bearing
J. Snorkel Shaft
I 32. To remove the snorkel shaft from the snorkel tube, use a 8
press to press the snorkel shaft out.
H
G
A
CD
B
E
A
8.31
Sportsman X2 Transmission
33. To remove the remaining bearing on the snorkel shaft (15), 3. Inspect the output gear assembly (1), replace bearings if
remove the retaining ring and press the bearing off. needed. Inspect the 91T gear for damage, chips, or
abnormal worn teeth.
15
Transmission assembly
1. Install all new seals in the gearcases. Use the Rear Output
1
Seal Driver (PN 2871698) and Rear Driveshaft Seal Guide
(PN 2871699) to install the seals into the gearcases. See
illustration 1 to identify seals for replacement.
2871698
2871699
LH Gearcase
Cover Seals
5. Install the snorkel shaft assembly into the gearcase. Install
the snorkel shaft assembly in until the second O-ring is
contacting the gearcase, but is still visible.
Gearcase Seal
2. Reverse the disassembly procedure for the assembly of the
snorkel shaft assembly.
8.32
Sportsman X2 Transmission
6. Install the output gear assembly. Be sure to properly mesh snorkel shaft counterclockwise to the next notch or 8th
the snorkel shaft bevel gear with the output bevel gear. notch.
Install the 4 torx screws (2) to secure the output gear
assembly into place. Torque screws to .
NOTICE! : It is important to set zero lash between the
output gear and the snorkel shaft gear. If there is binding or
excess lash, tighten or loosen the snorkel shaft until there
is zero lash. Notches
=T
Output Gear Retaining Screw Torque:
8-12 ft.lbs. (11-17 Nm)
8.33
Sportsman X2 Transmission
2. Once the gear backlash is found, to install the snorkel lock 4. Assemble the input shaft assembly if previously
screw, you may have to rotate the snorkel tube clockwise disassembled.
or counterclockwise slightly. This will allow the lock screw A. Ball Bearing Input Shaft Assembly
to thread itself into one of the slots of the snorkel tube (See B. Input Shaft
illustration below) to secure the snorkel tube. C. Silent Chain
Screw Fits in Slots of Snorkel Tube
A
B
H
G F
E
3. With the snorkel shaft assembly in place, remove the 4 Torx D
screws from the output shaft assembly. Remove the output C
shaft assembly.
B
A
Towards Inside
of Case
8.34
Sportsman X2 Transmission
6. Inspect the shift drum for any damage or wear. Inspect the NOTE: To ease assembly use a plastic tie strap to hold
splines of the shift drum. Replace the O-rings on the end of the shift forks (D) and the shift drum (C) together during
the shift drum and lubricate them before assembly. assembly.
C
= In. / mm.
8. The shift drum (C), reverse shaft (D), input shaft (E), and
output gear assembly must be installed at the same time to
properly align all components.
E
8.35
Sportsman X2 Transmission
10. With all of the components in the correct positions install 12. Install the rear drive differential and drive chain, following
the 4 output gear assembly screws. Apply Loctite 262 these precautions:
(PN 2871952) to the threads of the screws. Torque the
screws to specification. NOTE: If the transmission is in The case half rear output seal should be removed prior
to installation of the differential, as seal damage can
locked in Park, place the transmission in Neutral. occur with seal installed due to the angle of entry.
Install the differential sliding geardog onto the shift
fork arms at the same time the silent chain is installed.
The differential gear bearing may be lightly tapped into
place. The output seal can be installed once the
assembly is in place.
=T
Output Gear Retaining Screws:
8-12 ft.lbs. (11-17 Nm)
11. Install the oil deflector shield into the gearcase. Apply
Loctite 242 to the threads of the screws. Torque the 13. Tensioner Installation:
screws to specification. NOTE: Case-halve mating may be difficult due to tensioner
pressure on the drive chain during installation. Release tension at
the ratcheting cam to aid case half installation. Release the
tensioner spring after the case halves are mated but not yet
touching.
=T
Oil Deflector Retaining Screws:
16-30 in.lbs. (2-3.6 Nm)
8.36
Sportsman X2 Transmission
14. Lift the leg of the spring up and over the rear pin. The 15. Apply a continuous bead of Crankcase Sealant (3-Bond)
tensioner cam will lift the shoe and tension chain. (PN 2871557) to the LH gearcase mating surface and install
Tensioner Assembly - Top View the cover. Install and tighten the 22 screws in a criss cross
pattern to evenly secure the cover. Torque the screws to
specification.
NOTE: Case-halve mating may be difficult due to tensioner
pressure on the drive chain during installation. Release tension at
Forward the ratcheting cam to aid case half installation. Release the
tensioner spring after the case halves are mated but not yet
touching.
Lock Cam
=T
View From Left Side of Transmission Gearcase Bolt Torque:
25-30 ft.lbs. (36-43 Nm)
Forward
16. Place a small amount of grease (PN 2871551) into the
pocket before installing the sector gear.
8.37
Sportsman X2 Transmission
17. Install the shift gear (16T) (G) on the shift drum shaft. 20. Install the compression spring (K).
Install the sector gear (F) in the bushing pocket on the left
side. Aligning the timing marks on the gears.
G
H
Timing marks
18. Install the O-ring (if not yet done) and lockout disc (H) onto 21. Apply Crankcase Sealant (3-Bond) (PN 2871557) onto the
the shift drum shaft. Be sure to install the lockout disc (H) cover and case mating surfaces. Install the cover and torque
and detent star (J) with the raised edge facing outward. the bolts to specification
=T
Shift Shaft Cover Bolt Torque:
12-18 ft.lbs. (16-26 Nm)
22. Install the bellcrank onto the shift shaft. Note the key
splined on the bellcrank and shaft. Install the nut. Torque
the nut to specification.
H
=T
Bellcrank Nut Torque:
12-18 ft.lbs. (16-26 Nm)
19. Install the detent pawl (I) onto the shift shaft. Install the
detent star (J). Install a new O-ring onto the shift shaft. 23. Install the transmission switch and secure the switch with
Apply a small amount of grease onto the O-rings and end the retaining ring.
of the shift drum.
8.38
BRAKES
CHAPTER 9
BRAKES
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
TORQUE TABLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
COMPONENT SERVICE LIMITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
BRAKE SYSTEM EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3
X2 SYSTEM COMPONENT EXPLODED VIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3
SPORTSMAN SYSTEM COMPONENT EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.4
BRAKE CALIPER EXPLODED VIEWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
SPORTSMAN AND X2 FRONT CALIPER ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
X2 REAR CALIPER ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
SPORTSMAN REAR CALIPER ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6
HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6
BRAKE NOISE TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
BRAKE BLEEDING / FLUID CHANGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
FRONT MASTER CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9
FRONT BRAKES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.10
PAD REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.10
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.11
BRAKE BURNISHING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12
FRONT BRAKE DISC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12
REMOVAL / REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.13
FRONT CALIPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.14
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.14
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.15
REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.15
INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.16
REAR BRAKE PAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.17
X2 PAD REMOVAL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.17
X2 PAD INSTALLATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.18
SPORTSMAN REAR PAD REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.19
SPORTSMAN REAR PAD INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.20
BRAKE BURNISHING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.20
X2 REAR CALIPER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.21
REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.21
9
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.22
REASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.22
SPORTSMAN REAR CALIPER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.23
REMOVAL AND INSPECTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.23
ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.24
REAR BRAKE DISC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.25
INSPECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.25
REAR MASTER CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.26
X2 EXPLODED VIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.26
OVERVIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.27
X2 REAR MASTER CYLINDER REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.27
SPORTSMAN REAR MASTER CYLINDER REMOVAL / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . 9.28
PEDAL REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
TROUBLESHOOTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
BRAKES SQUEAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
POOR BRAKE PERFORMANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
LEVER VIBRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
CALIPER OVERHEATS (BRAKES DRAG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
BRAKES LOCK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
9.1
BRAKES
SPECIFICATIONS
Torque Table
NOTE: Refer to tightening procedures in this chapter. Some special procedures are used when torquing
certain bolts and fasteners.
9.2
BRAKES
BRAKE SYSTEM EXPLODED VIEWS
X2 System Component Exploded View
1) Master Cylinder Cover Screws: 7 in.lbs. (0.79 Nm)
2) Banjo Style Fitting: 15 ft.lbs. (21 Nm)
3) Flare Style Fittings: 12-15 ft.lbs. (16-21 Nm)
4) Brake Switch: 12-15 ft.lbs. (16-21 Nm) *Apply Pipe Sealant to Threads
5) Dual Input Master Cylinder and Bleed Screw: 25-30 in. lbs. (2.8-3.4 Nm)
6) Front and Rear Caliper Bleed Screws: 36-60 in. lbs. (4.07-6.78 Nm)
2
1
3
4
2
6
3
9
3
2
9.3
9.4
BRAKES
B 3
E
G
H
C
E G
B
9
H
D
3 F
9.5
BRAKES
Sportsman Rear Caliper Assembly
16-18 ft.lbs. A
(22-24 Nm)
C
Apply Polaris DOT approved Brake fluid D
3 to component. E
30-35 ft.lbs. 3G B
(41-48 Nm) H 25-30 in lbs.
(2.80-3.40 Nm)
I
A. Anvil Bolts
K F B. Bleed Screws
3 C. Washers
D. O-rings
E. Rear Housing
F. Seals
G. Piston
M J H. Slide Pins
I. Bushings
J. Seal
K. Bracket
L. Pad
M.Front Housing
N. Retaining Clips
N L
HYDRAULIC BRAKE SYSTEM When the hand activated brake lever (A) is applied it contacts
piston (B) within the master cylinder. As the master cylinder
piston moves inward it closes a small opening (compensating
Operation Overview port C) within the cylinder and starts to build pressure within the
brake system. As the pressure within the system is increased,
Must be clear to Compensating port the piston (D) located in the brake caliper moves outward and
compensates for applies pressure to the brake pad. This pad contacts the brake
allow proper E temperature changes by disc and moves the caliper in its floating bracket, pulling the
diaphragm
movement allowing fluid back to stationary side pad into the brake disc. The resulting friction
master cylinder reduces brake disc and vehicle speed. As the lever pressure is
increased, the braking affect is also increased.
The friction applied to the brake pads will cause the pads to
F C wear. As these pads wear, the piston within the caliper moves
further outward and becomes self adjusting. Fluid from the
reservoir fills the additional area created when the caliper piston
moves outward.
Brake fluid level is critical to proper system operation. Too little
fluid will allow air to enter the system and cause the brakes to
A B feel spongy. Too much fluid could cause brakes to drag due to
fluid expansion.
Located within the master cylinder is the compensating port (C)
which is opened and closed by the master cylinder piston
assembly. The port is open when the lever is released and the
D master cylinder piston is outward. As the temperature within the
Move Brake Pad hydraulic system changes, this port compensates for fluid
expansion (heated fluid) or contraction (cooled fluid). During
system service, be sure this port is open. Due to the high
temperatures created within the system during heavy braking, it
is very important that the master cylinder reservoir has adequate
The Polaris disc brake system consists of the following space to allow for fluid expansion. Never overfill the
components or assemblies: brake lever; master cylinder; reservoir! Fill to 1/4, - 5/16, (.64 - .80 cm) from top of the
hydraulic hose; brake calipers (slave cylinder); brake pads; and cylinder.
brake discs, which are secured to the drive line.
9.6
BRAKES
This system also incorporates a diaphragm (E) as part of the BRAKE NOISE TROUBLESHOOTING
cover gasket; and a vent port (F) located between the gasket and
the cover. The combination diaphragm and vent allow for the air
above the fluid to equalize pressure as the fluid expands or POSSIBLE CAUSE REMEDY
contracts. Make sure the vent is open and allowed to function.
If the reservoir is over filled or the diaphragm vent is plugged the Operator error (riding the
expanding fluid may build pressure in the brake system leading brake / park brake Educate operator
to brake fail
applied)
When servicing Polaris ATV brake systems, use only Polaris
DOT-approved brake fluid. Tighten wheel, hub nuts or
Loose wheel hub or bearings
replace bearings if worn
Brake disc warped or
WARNING excessively worn
Replace disc
Once a bottle is opened, use what is necessary and Brake disc misaligned or Inspect and repair as
discard the rest in accordance with local laws. Do loose necessary
not store or use a partial bottle of brake fluid. Brake If noise does not change when
fluid is hygroscopic, meaning it rapidly absorbs Noise is from other source
brake is applied check other
moisture. This causes the boiling temperature of (chain, axle, hub, disc or
sources. Inspect and repair as
the brake fluid to drop, which can lead to brake fade wheel)
necessary
and the possible loss of control.
Wrong pad for Change to a softer or harder
conditions pad (if available)
Brake Noise Troubleshooting
Dirt or dust buildup on the brake pads and disc is the most Brake Bleeding / Fluid Change
common cause of brake noise (squeal caused by vibration). If
cleaning does not reduce the occurrence of brake noise, a NOTE: When bleeding the brakes or replacing the
product such as Permatex Disc Brake Quiet can be applied to fluid, always start with the caliper farthest from the
the back of the pads. Follow directions on the package. This will
keep pads in contact with caliper piston(s) to reduce the chance master cylinder.
of squeaks caused by dirt or dust.
9.7
BRAKES
3. Inspect vent slots (A) in cover and remove any debris or 6. Slowly pump the brake lever until pressure builds and
blockage. holds.
C Sight Glass
7. While maintaining lever pressure, open bleeder screw.
Close bleeder screw and release brake lever.
D
NOTE: Do not release lever before bleeder screw is
B tight or air may be drawn into caliper.
A
8. Repeat procedure until clean fluid appears in bleeder hose
and all air has been purged. Add fluid as necessary to
maintain level in reservoir.
=T
Bleeder Screw Torque:
25-30 in.lbs. (2.80-3.40 Nm)
9.8
BRAKES
12. Install diaphragm, sight glass, cap and screws. 15. Field test machine at low speed before putting into service.
Check for proper braking action and lever reserve. With
Master Cylinder Cap lever firmly applied, lever reserve should be no less than 1/
2, (1.3 cm) from handlebar.
16. Check brake system for fluid leaks and inspect all hoses and
lines for wear or abrasion. Replace hose if wear or abrasion
Sight Glass
is found.
Installation
Cap Must be Even
1. Install master cylinder on handlebars. Torque mounting
bolts to specification. Torque the inner bolt first as
indicated in the illustration below.
14. Torque the screw to specification . 7 in.lbs. (.79 Nm)
25 in.lbs. (3 Nm)
7 in.lbs. (0.79 Nm)
Torque Inner
Bolt First
=T
=T
Master Cylinder Mount Bolt Torque:
Master Cylinder Cover Screw Torque: 25 in. lbs. (3 Nm)
7 in.lbs. (0.79 Nm) Torque Inner Bolt First
9.9
BRAKES
2. Place new sealing washers on each side of banjo fitting on FRONT BRAKES
the brake line and torque banjo bolt to specification.
Torque to 15 ft.lbs. (21 Nm) Pad Removal
Sealing Washer 1. Elevate and support the of the ATV.
CAUTION
Banjo Bolt
Use care when supporting vehicle so that it does not
tip or fall. Severe injury may occur.
=T
Banjo Bolt Torque:
15 ft.lbs. (21 Nm)
9.10
BRAKES
5. Push caliper piston into caliper bore slowly using a C-
clamp or locking pliers with pads installed.
Measure Pad
6. Push mounting bracket inward and slip outer brake pad past
Assembly
edge. Remove inner pad.
1. Lubricate mounting bracket pins with a light film of
Polaris Premium All Season Grease (PN 2871423), and
install rubber dust boots.
9.11
BRAKES
2. Compress mounting bracket and make sure dust boots are 5. Install the adjuster screw and turn clockwise until
fully seated. Install pads with friction material facing each stationary pad contacts disc, then back off 1/2 turn
other. (counterclockwise).
If pads are contaminated with grease, oil, or liquid 7. Install wheels and torque wheel nuts. It is required that a
soaked do not use the pads. Use only new clean pads. burnishing procedure be performed after installation of new
brake pads to extend service life and reduce noise.
3. Install caliper on hub strut, and torque mounting bolts.
NOTE: Front Wheel Nut Torque: Refer to Chapter 2.
4. Slowly pump the brake lever until pressure has been built
up. Maintain at least 1/2, (12.7 mm) of brake fluid in the
reservoir to prevent air from entering the brake system.
9.12
BRAKES
2. Measure the disc thickness at eight different points around Removal / Replacement
the pad contact surface. Replace disc if worn beyond
service limit. NOTE: To reduce the possibility of warping, try
removing the brake disc mounting bolts before
applying heat to the bolts.
= In. / mm.
CAUTION
= In. / mm.
9.13
BRAKES
FRONT CALIPER 3. Remove mounting bracket, pin assembly and dust boot.
Removal
CAUTION
Clean Components
2. Push upper pad retainer pin inward and slip brake pads past
edge. Loosen pad adjuster.
9.14
BRAKES
Inspection Reassembly
1. Inspect caliper body for nicks, scratches or wear. Measure 1. Install new caliper seals (A) in the caliper body (B). Be
bore size and compare to specifications. Replace if damage sure groove is clean and free of residue or brakes may drag
is evident or if worn beyond service limit. upon assembly.
C
B
3. Inspect the brake disc and pads as outlined for brake pad
replacement in this section. See BRAKE PAD
INSPECTION earlier in this chapter.
9.15
BRAKES
4. Compress the mounting bracket and make sure the dust 6. Install brake line and torque the banjo bolt to specification.
seals are fully seated. Install the brake pads. Clean the disc
and pads with brake parts cleaner or denatured alcohol to
=T
remove any dirt, oil or grease.
Brake Line Banjo Bolt Torque:
15 ft.lbs. (21 Nm)
Installation
5. Install caliper on hub strut, and torque mounting bolts to
specification.
15 ft.lbs. (21 Nm)
8. Perform brake bleeding procedure as outlined earlier in this
chapter.
18 ft.lbs.
(24 Nm)
=T
Brake Caliper Mounting Bolt Torque:
18 ft.lbs. (24 Nm)
9.16
BRAKES
REAR BRAKE PAD 5. Push caliper piston into the caliper bore slowly using a C-
clamp or locking pliers with pads installed.
X2 Pad Removal
1. Elevate and support the rear of the ATV.
4. Remove the two caliper mounting bolts and lift caliper off
the brake disc.
9.17
BRAKES
9. Measure the thickness of the pad material. Replace pads if 3. Install caliper and torque the mounting bolts to
worn beyond the service limit. specification.
Measure
Thickness
= In. / mm.
=T
Rear Brake Pad Thickness
Service Limit: .180 (4.6 mm) Caliper Mount Bolt Torque:
18 ft.lbs. (24 Nm)
X2 Pad Installation 4. Slowly pump the brake lever until pressure has been built
up. Maintain at least 1/2, (12.7 mm) of brake fluid in the
1. Lubricate mounting bracket pins with a light film of
reservoir to prevent air from entering the brake system.
Polaris Premium All Season Grease (PN 2871423), and
install rubber dust boots. 5. Install the adjuster screw and turn clockwise until the
stationary pad contacts the disc, then back off 1/2 turn
(counterclockwise).
9.18
BRAKES
Sportsman Rear Pad Removal NOTE: When removing caliper, be careful not to
damage brake line. Support caliper so as not to kink
1. Support the machine. Remove the rear tire. or bend brake line.
2. Remove the slide pin clips from the slide bolt.
5. Push caliper pistons into caliper bore slowly with pads
installed.
6. Remove the caliper slide pins and remove the brake pads
from the caliper.
3. Loosen the slide pins with a hex wrench. Remove Rear Pads
Measure
Thickness
4. Remove caliper mounting bolts and lift caliper off of disc.
9
= In. / mm.
9.19
BRAKES
Sportsman Rear Pad Installation 4. Install the slide bolt snap ring. Torque the slide pin to
specification.
1. Install new brake pads in caliper body.
Install Pads
30-35 ft.lbs.
(41-48 Nm)
WARNING =T
If the brake pads are contaminated with grease, Caliper Slide Bolt Torque:
oil, or liquid soaked do not use the pads, 30-35 ft.lbs. (41-48Nm)
use only new clean pads.
5. Slowly pump the brake lever until pressure has been built
2. Install and tighten the slide pin with a hex wrench. up. Maintain at least 1/2, (12.7 mm) of brake fluid in the
3. Install caliper and torque the mounting bolts to reservoir to prevent air from entering the master cylinder.
specification. 6. It is recommended that a burnishing procedure be
performed after installation of new brake pads to extend
service life and reduce noise.
=T
Caliper Mount Bolt Torque:
18 ft.lbs. (24 Nm)
9.20
BRAKES
X2 REAR CALIPER 6. Remove piston, dust seals and piston seals.
Removal
CAUTION
Clean Components
9.21
BRAKES
Inspection Reassembly
1. Inspect caliper body for nicks, scratches or wear. Measure 1. Install new caliper seals (A) in the caliper body (B). Be
bore size and compare to specifications. Replace if damage sure groove is clean and free of residue or brakes may drag
is evident or if worn beyond service limit. upon assembly.
C
B
3. Inspect the brake disc and pads as outlined for brake pad
replacement in this section. See BRAKE PAD
INSPECTION earlier in this chapter.
9.22
BRAKES
4. Compress the mounting bracket and make sure the dust 4. Remove the slide bolt snap rings (A), the slide pins (B), the
seals are fully seated. Install the brake pads. Clean the disc bracket pad (C), and the brake pads (D).
and pads with brake parts cleaner or denatured alcohol to
remove any dirt, oil or grease. Caliper C
B
A
Seal
Pistons & O-ring
Anvil Bolts
Bushing
9.23
BRAKES
9. Measure the inside diameter of the rear caliper. The caliper Assembly
body is a 2-step piston. The rear step is measured as well
as the outside step. 1. Install new O-rings in the slide bolt bushing holes. Be sure
O-ring and seal grooves are thoroughly cleaned of all
residue, or piston may bind in bore. Apply brake fluid to
piston seals and install carefully with a twisting motion to
ease assembly until fully seated.
Seals
= In. / mm.
Rear Caliper Piston Bore I.D. 2. Carefully assemble caliper body, making sure O-rings are
Inner Bore Service Limit: .94 (23.88 mm) properly positioned in groove. Tighten the caliper anvil
Outer Bore Service Limit: 1.5 (38.1 mm) bolts and then torque the anvil bolts evenly to specification.
10. Inspect caliper piston bore for scratches, severe corrosion, 16-18 ft.lbs. (22-24
or galling and replace if necessary.
Inspect
=T
11. Inspect surface of caliper piston for nicks, scratches, or Caliper Anvil Bolt Torque:
damage and replace if necessary. 16-18 ft.lbs. (22-24 Nm)
9.24
BRAKES
NOTE: The slide pins should be torqued when REAR BRAKE DISC
installed on caliper mount.
Inspection
1. Visually inspect disc for scoring, scratches, or gouges.
Replace the disc if any deep scratches are evident.
=T
Slide Pin Torque:
30-35 ft.lbs. (41-48 Nm)
30-35 ft.lbs.
(41-48 Nm) Disc Thickness
18 ft.lbs.
= In. / mm.
(24 Nm)
Brake Disc Thickness:
Service Limit: .170 (4.318 mm)
= In. / mm.
9
=T
Brake Disc Thickness Variance:
Caliper Mounting Bolt Torque: Service Limit: .002 (.051 mm)
16-18 ft.lbs. (22-24 Nm) Between Measurements
5. Install brake line and tighten securely with a line wrench. 3. Mount dial indicator and measure disc runout. Replace the
Torque the brake lines to the proper torque specification. disc if runout exceeds specifications.
6. Follow bleeding procedure outlined in the BLEEDING
PROCEDURE in this chapter.
7. Field test unit for proper braking action before putting into
= In. / mm.
service. Inspect for fluid leaks and firm brakes. Make sure
the brake is not dragging when lever is released. If the brake Brake Disc Runout
drags, re-check assembly and installation. Service Limit: .010 / .254 mm
9.25
BRAKES
REAR MASTER CYLINDER
X2 Exploded View
J I
A
H
F E
9.26
BRAKES
Overview 2. If required, remove the rear brake line from the master
cylinder. Use a suitable container to catch the brake fluid.
Polaris disc brake systems are light weight, low maintenance Dispose of brake fluid properly.
and perform well in the conditions ATVs routinely encounter.
However, there are a few things to remember when replacing
disc brake pads or performing brake system service to ensure Brake Fluid Reservoir
proper system function and maximum pad service life.
Perform a brake burnishing procedure after installing
new pads to maximize service life.
Optional pads are available to suit conditions in your
area. Select a pad to fit riding style and environment.
Rear Brake Line Front Brake Line
Do not over-fill the master cylinder fluid reservoir.
Make sure the brake lever and pedal returns freely and
completely.
Adjust stop pin on caliper (if applicable) after pad Frame
service.
Check and adjust master cylinder reservoir fluid level
after pad service.
Rear Brake MC
Make sure atmospheric vent on reservoir is
unobstructed. Brake Mount
Test for brake drag after any brake system service and
investigate cause if brake drag is evident. Spring
Make sure caliper moves freely on guide pins (where
applicable). Brake Lever
9.27
BRAKES
Sportsman Rear Master Cylinder Removal / 5. Reinstall the brake line and torque the banjo bolt to
Installation specification depending on the style of fitting.
A SPORTSMAN
B
J
C
15 ft.lbs.
(21 Nm)
A. Brake Reservoir
B. Rear Foot Brake Line
C. Rear Master Cylinder
D D. Master Cylinder Bolts
E. Bushing
K F. Washer
I G. Cotter Pin
H. Foot Pedal
I. Mount Plate Bolts
J. Mount Plate
F K. Spring
G E H
9.28
BRAKES
Pedal Removal and Installation TROUBLESHOOTING
Brakes Squeal
Dirty/contaminated friction pads
Improper alignment
Worn disc
Worn disc splines
X2 Shown
Poor Brake Performance
Air in system
Water in system (brake fluid contaminated)
Caliper/disc misaligned
1. Remove the RH footwell to gain access to the rear master Caliper dirty or damaged
cylinder.
2. Remove the cotter key. Brake line damaged or lining ruptured
Worn disc and/or friction pads
3. Remove the washers, bushings, and tension spring.
Incorrectly adjusted lever
4. Reverse the steps for installation, use a new cotter key
during installation. Incorrectly adjusted stationary pad
Worn or damaged master cylinder or components
Improper clearance between lever and switch
Lever Vibration
Disc damaged
Disc worn (runout or thickness variance exceeds
service limit)
Brakes Lock
Alignment of caliper to disc
9.29
BRAKES
NOTES
9.30
ELECTRICAL
CHAPTER 10
ELECTRICAL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.3
OVERVIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.3
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.4
SETTING A NEW SERVICE INTERVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.6
EFI DIAGNOSTIC MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.7
SPEEDOMETER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.8
SPEEDOMETER INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.9
SPEEDOMETER TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.10
TEST 1 - NO ALL WHEEL DRIVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.10
TEST 2 - NO DISPLAY / TEST 3 - NO REVERSE SPEED LIMIT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.11
TEST 4 - NO AWD HUB SAFETY LIMITER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.12
TEST 5 - REVERSE SPEED LIMITER / TEST 6 - SPEED SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.13
TEST 7 - NO FUEL GAUGE / TEST 8 - TRANSMISSION SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.14
ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (ADC) COIL. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
DIAGNOSING SYSTEM FAILURES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
ALL WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) COIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
OPERATION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
DIAGNOSING SYSTEM FAILURES. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
COOLING SYSTEM COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
FAN CONTROL CIRCUIT OPERATION / TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
FAN CONTROL CIRCUIT BYPASS TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
FAN MOTOR CURRENT DRAW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.17
GEAR POSITION INDICATOR SWITCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.17
TEST DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.17
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL (ETC) SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
ETC SWITCH OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
ETC OPERATION TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
IGNITION SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.19
FLYWHEEL IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.19
EFI - DC/CDI IGNITION OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.19
ALTERNATOR/IGNITION COMPONENTS - 700/800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.20
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR GAP. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
IGNITION SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
CHARGING SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
CURRENT DRAW - KEY OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
CHARGING SYSTEM BREAK EVEN TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.22
ALTERNATOR OUTPUT TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.22
CHARGING SYSTEM TESTING FLOW CHART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.24
RELAYS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.25
OPERATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.25
FUSES/CIRCUIT BREAKER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26
10
OPERATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26
10.1
ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26
HIGH BEAM HEADLIGHT BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26
HEADLIGHT HOUSING REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.27
HIGH BEAM HEADLIGHT ADJUSTMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.28
LOWER HEADLAMP REMOVAL / INSTALLATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.28
LOW BEAM HEADLIGHT ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.29
HEADLAMP SWITCH TEST. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.29
SPORTSMAN WORK LIGHT SWITCH (DELUXE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.30
SPORTSMAN BRAKE LIGHT / WORK LIGHT (DELUXE) REPLACEMENT. . . . . . . . 10.30
X2 BRAKE LIGHT / WORK LIGHT (DELUXE) REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.31
BRAKE LIGHT SWITCH. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.32
FUEL SENDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
X2 DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
SOLENOID TESTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
SOLENOID REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
DIFFERENTIAL RELAY OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
DIFFERENTIAL RELAY TESTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
X2 SPEED SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
REPLACEMENT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
ACCESSORY POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.35
WIRE CONNECTIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.35
STARTER SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.36
700/800 STARTER LOCKOUT OVERVIEW AND DIAGNOSTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.36
800 X2 STARTER LOCKOUT OVERVIEW AND DIAGNOSTIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.37
TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
VOLTAGE DROP TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
STARTER MOTOR REMOVAL / DISASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
BRUSH INSPECTION / REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.39
ARMATURE TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.40
STARTER REASSEMBLY / INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.41
STARTER SOLENOID BENCH TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.41
STARTER DRIVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.42
STARTER EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.43
STARTER SYSTEM TESTING FLOW CHART. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.44
BASIC WINCH WIRING- PRE-WIRED MODELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.45
BATTERY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.46
BATTERY IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.46
BATTERY ACTIVATION (CONVENTIONAL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.46
BATTERY TERMINALS/BOLTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.47
CONVENTIONAL BATTERY INSPECTION / REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.47
CONVENTIONAL BATTERY INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.47
CONVENTIONAL BATTERY TESTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.48
CONVENTIONAL BATTERY OCV - OPEN CIRCUIT VOLTAGE TEST . . . . . . . . . . . 10.48
CONVENTIONAL BATTERY SPECIFIC GRAVITY TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.48
BATTERY LOAD TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
OFF SEASON STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
CHARGING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.50
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY CHARGING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.50
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY INSPECTION / REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.51
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY INSTALLATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.51
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY - OCV- OPEN CIRCUIT VOLTAGE TEST . . . . . . . 10.52
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY LOAD TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.52
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY OFF-SEASON STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.53
LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY CHARGING PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.53
10.2
ELECTRICAL
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER Introduction
Refer To Illustration 1:
Overview
(A) Speedometer Needle (flashes during warning condition) The Polaris ATV Instrument Cluster is powered by battery
voltage (12 VDC) and requires inputs from the engine RPM,
transmission gear, and speed sensor for proper operation. Two
(B) Speedometer harnesses plug into the cluster head; one from the speed sensor,
in MPH/KPH and one from the vehicle main harness. A non-serviceable
internal memory battery maintains odometer and hour meter
data when the machine is not running. The illumination lamp
inside the gauge is non-serviceable and is designed to last for the
life of the unit. (A) The speedometer needle indicates speed
from an electronic speed sensor. The needle also flashes during
a warning condition. The speedometer needle indicates speed in
MPH and KPH. NOTE: A flashing needle could indicate a hot
engine, low battery warning, or the No. 10 Pin could be
grounded. (B) The speedometer face features numbers in Mile
Per Hour (MPH) and Kilometers Per Hour (KPH). (C) The
Rider Information Center performs a number of functions (See
Illustration 2):
1. Odometer / Tachometer / Trip meter / Hour Meter / Clock
Odometer records the miles traveled by the ATV.
Tachometer displays engine RPM. This feature will
also display with the vehicle in motion NOTE: Small
RPM fluctuations from day to day are normal because
ILL. 1 of changes in humidity, temperature, and elevation
(C) Rider Information Center
Trip meter records the miles traveled by the ATV if
reset before each trip or total miles to 999. To reset the
trip meter, select the trip meter mode. Press and hold
4 1 9 the mode button (override button) until the total
5 2 changes to 0. NOTE: In the Rider Information Center,
the trip meter display contains a decimal point, but the
odometer displays without a decimal point.
3 Hour meter logs the total hours the engine has been in
operation.
Clock - displays hours and minutes.
2. Programmable Service Interval / Diagnostic Mode
6
Service Interval - The purpose of the programmable
service interval is to provide the consumer and the
dealer with a convenient way to schedule routine
7 9 8 ILL. 2 maintenance. When the ATV leaves the factory, this
feature is set at 50 hours". When the first 50 hours of
engine operation are finished the wrench icon will flash
for 10 seconds each time the ATV is started as a
reminder that ATV maintenance is due. NOTE: To reset
the Service Interval, follow the directions for
SETTING NEW SERVICE INTERVAL later in this
chapter.
3. Check Engine Warning Indicator 10
The word HOT will display alpha numerically when the
engine is overheating. Do not continue to operate the
ATV if this warning appears. Refer to Chapter 3
COOLING SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING for
help with diagnosis of overheating.
10.3
ELECTRICAL
4. High/Low Battery Voltage Instrument Cluster Diagnostic Mode
This warning usually indicates that the ATV is being NOTE: This gauge features auto shut-off protection
operated at an RPM too low to keep the battery if the voltage on the DC bus is excessive. This is
charged. A low battery warning may also occur under
normal operation if the machine is at idle and high usually the result of an open battery condition, and
electrical load (lights, cooling fan, accessories) is the gauge is designed to survive such an event.
applied. Driving at a higher RPM or connecting a
battery charger will usually clear the warning. This
indicator may also turn in the event of an overcharging NOTE: If the gauge will not indicate what gear it is in
situation, such as a faulty voltage regulator. and will not allow AWD operation, AWD can still be
enabled by holding in the mode/override button.
5. Engine Hour Display Indicator
Displays number of hours of engine operation. 1. Turn the key switch off and wait 10 seconds.
2. Set the park brake and shift the transmission to neutral.
6. AWD Indicator 3. Hold the mode/reverse override button as you turn the key
Illuminates when the electrical portion of the AWD switch on.
system is enabled. 4. Release the switch as soon as the display is activated.
7. Gear Indicator Use the mode/reverse override button to toggle through the
diagnostic screens.
Specifies what position the shift lever and transmission
are in. This area is blank if a fault occurs. NOTE: The initial screen display refers to the
8. Mode Indicator software version installed on your ATV. This
information is only displayed briefly.
Indicates which modes are being utilized.
Screen 1 - Clock: This screen allows for setting the time of day.
9. Fuel Gauge To reset the clock:
The segments of the fuel gauge indicate the level of fuel 1. Enter the diagnostic mode.
in the fuel tank. When the last segment clears, a low 2. Toggle to the clock screen.
fuel warning is activated. All related icons will flash,
FUEL will display in the LCD, and the speedometer 3. Press and hold the mode button until the hour display
needle will blink. If riding, be sure to refuel flashes. Release the button.
immediately.
4. Press and release the mode button once to advance the
setting by one hour. Press and hold the mode button to
advance the hours quickly.
5. When the desired hour is displayed, wait approximately
four seconds, until the minute display flashes.
6. When the display stops flashing, the mode has been set.
7. Use the same procedure to reset the minutes.
Ill. 2
10.4
ELECTRICAL
Screen 2 - Tachometer: (Ill. 3) indicates engine rpm. NOTE: 10--20% Variance from these reading is within
normal parameters.
Ill.3
23 Ohms in Park
Screen 3 - AWD Diagnostic Screen: This screen indicates
whether or not current is flowing through the AWD coil on
models with AWD.
AWD Off
158 Ohms in Neutral
AWD On
10.5
ELECTRICAL
Setting A New Service Interval
1. While in the service interval mode, press and hold the
mode/override button until the wrench icon flashes. When
it begins to flash, release the button.
2. The setting will increase by one hour each time the button
is pressed. Pressing and holding the button will allow the
numbers to escalate much faster.
3. When the desired time increment is displayed, release the
button and wait for the wrench to stop flashing. When the
wrench stops blinking, your service hours are set.
NOTE: If you scroll past the intended number, hold
the button down until the count turns over to 0. You
can then reset the number.
297 Ohms in Low Turn Service Interval OFF:
1. If the service interval is enabled (functioning) on your
ATV and you wish to turn it off, toggle to the service
interval mode.
2. Press and hold the mode button for approximately 7
seconds until the word OFF appears in the Rider
Information Center. The service interval is now OFF. To
enable (turn on) the service interval mode, repeat the steps
above in Setting Service Interval After Countdown.
10.6
ELECTRICAL
Screen 6 - Miles/Kilometers: toggle, The display in the trip 2. Turn the key switch ON and OFF 3 times within 5 seconds,
meter and odometer can be changed to display either kilometers leaving the key switch in the ON position on the third turn.
or miles. The current display mode will be shown as KM or
MP. To change, hold in the mode button until the letters flash,
then press and release the button once. When the display stops
flashing, the mode has been set.
ON
KM = Kilometers
NOTE: As long as you are in the diagnostic mode, Example of how a failure code will appear.
the wrench icon will remain lit.
10.7
ELECTRICAL
Speedometer Removal
BLINK 1. Remove the three screws that secure the headlight pod
FAILURE DESCRIPTION cover and disconnect the wire connectors from the
CODE
instrument cluster.
No RPM Signal
21 Loss of Synchronization
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Circuit Low
45
Input
Barometric Pressure Sensor: Circuit High
46
Input
22 TPS: Open or Short Circuit to Ground
22 TPS: Short Circuit to Battery
23 RAM Error: Defective ECU
Engine Temp Sensor Circuit:
42
Short to Ground
Engine Temp Sensor Circuit: Open or Short 2. Push the instrument cluster out from the backside of the
42
to Battery pod, while securely holding the pod.
51 Injector 1: Open Load
51 Injector 1: Short Circuit to Ground
51 Injector 1: Short Circuit to Battery
52 Injector 2: Open Load
52 Injector 2: Short Circuit to Ground
52 Injector 2: Short Circuit to Battery
54 Engine Temp Lamp: Open Load
54 Engine Temp Lamp: Short Circuit to Ground
54 Engine Temp Lamp: Short Circuit to Battery
55 Diag Lamp: Open Load
55 Diag Lamp: Short Circuit to Ground
Bezel
55 Diag Lamp: Short Circuit to Battery Instrument Bezel
10.8
ELECTRICAL
Speedometer Installation
1. Spray a soap and water mixture onto the outer surface area
of the instrument cluster. This will help the instrument
cluster slide into the pod assembly more easily.
10
10.9
ELECTRICAL
SPEEDOMETER TROUBLESHOOTING
Test 1 - No All Wheel Drive
10.10
ELECTRICAL
TEST 2 - No Display / TEST 3 - No Reverse Speed Limit
10
10.11
ELECTRICAL
TEST 4 - No AWD Hub Safety Limiter
10.12
ELECTRICAL
TEST 5 - Reverse Speed Limiter / TEST 6 - Speed Sensor
10
10.13
ELECTRICAL
TEST 7 - No Fuel Gauge / TEST 8 - Transmission Switch
10.14
ELECTRICAL
ACTIVE DESCENT CONTROL (ADC) ALL WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) COIL
COIL
Operation Overview
Operation Overview
AWD switch must be ON. 12Vdc power is present at
AWD switch must be ON. 12Vdc power is present at the ADC hub coil.
the ADC hub coil. The instrument cluster senses grounding at pin #16.
ECU pin #11 controls the grounding of the ADC hub AWD icon should turn on at the instrument cluster.
coil for operation.
System must be grounded to operate.
ECU Pin #20 senses the gear signal indicating the
transmission is engaged and is not in Park or Neutral. Diagnosing System Failures
ECU pin #27 senses the speed sensor signal for Verify the AWD switch is functional.
determining if vehicle speed is below 15 Mph.
Verify the AWD hub coil is functional. Test the AWD
ECU senses the TPS position and will cancel ADC hub coil using an ohm meter.
operation if TPS moves off idle position.
System must be grounded to operate.
10
10.15
ELECTRICAL
COOLING SYSTEM COMPONENTS Coolant Temperature Sensor
The coolant temperature sensor can be tested using an ohmmeter
Fan Control Circuit Operation / Testing or voltmeter.
Power is supplied to the fan via the Orange/Black wire when the 1. With the engine and temperature sensor at room
relay is ON. The ground path for the fan motor is through the
Brown harness wire. Refer to RELAYS later in this chapter temperature (68F = 20C), disconnect the harness
for more information on fan functions. connector.
2. With the meter in the ohms mode, place the meter leads
onto the sensor contacts.
CAUTION 3. Use the table Temperature / Resistance table to determine
if the sensor needs to be replaced.
Keep hands away from fan blades during operation.
Serious personal injury could result.
TEMPERATURE F (C) RESISTANCE
NOTE: The fan may not function or operation may
68 F (20 C) 2.5 k 6%
be delayed if coolant level is low or if air is trapped in
the cooling system. Be sure cooling system is full 212 F (100 C) 0.186 2%
and purged of air. Refer to Maintenance Chapter 2
for cooling system information.
NOTE: If the coolant temperature sensor or circuit
malfunctions the radiator fan will default to 'ON'.
Fan Control Circuit Bypass Test
1. Disconnect harness from coolant temperature sensor on NOTE: The fan may not function or operation may
engine. be delayed if coolant level is low or if air is trapped in
2. With the ATV in Park and with the parking brake on, turn the cooling system. Be sure cooling system is full
the ignition key (and engine stop switch) ON. The fan and purged of air. Refer to Maintenance Chapter 2
should start running. for cooling system information.
3. If the fan does not run or runs slowly, check the fan motor
wiring, ground, motor condition and mechanical relay for
proper operation (refer to FAN MOTOR CURRENT
DRAW in this section). Repair or replace as necessary.
If the fan runs with the sensor harness disconnected, but
will not turn on when the engine is hot, check the coolant
temperature sensor and connector terminals.
10.16
ELECTRICAL
Fan Motor Current Draw GEAR POSITION INDICATOR SWITCH
A current draw test will provide a good indication of fan motor
condition. A worn or damaged fan motor will draw more Test Diagram
current, which causes a reduction in blade speed and reduced
cooling. NOTE: Also see INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
TROUBLESHOOTING for gear switch resistance.
Fan Motor
TRANSMISSION SWITCH
Org/Blk
High/Low/Neutral/Reverse/Park Switch
Org/Blk
Brn
Fan Harness
High Range
Low Range
Neutral
Reverse
Park
Green/White Brown/Red
1. Disconnect the harness from the coolant sensor. Violet (purple) White/Blue
2. Connect a DC ammeter in between the fan switch harness
Orange/Red Blue/Red
wires as shown.
3. Be sure fan blade is free to rotate.
4. Turn ignition key and engine stop switch to ON" position.
Read the current draw on ammeter with fan running.
5. If the fan motor draws more than 15 Amps, replace the
motor.
10
10.17
ELECTRICAL
ELECTRONIC THROTTLE CONTROL functioning properly, the engine will lose spark and stop.
(ETC) SWITCH
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC)
Switch (Composite Throttle Housing)
ETC Switch Operation
The Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system is designed to
stop the engine of an ATV in the event of a mechanical problem ETC Switch contacts are
with the throttle mechanism. The ETC switch is mounted closed in a fault condition
independently of the throttle actuator lever inside the throttle (throttle cable slack) Switch contacts are
block assembly. This is a normally closed switch, and is held in open during normal
the open position (contacts are separated (as shown below) by operations
throttle cable tension. The contacts are open" during normal
operation regardless of throttle lever position. In the event of a
mechanical problem in the throttle mechanism (cable tension is
lost), the switch contacts close, connecting the black wire to
ground, which prevents ignition spark. This is the same as
turning the key or engine stop switch OFF.
NOTE: Test the ETC switch at the harness
connector. ETC will not activate unless there is
throttle plate movement off of zero detected by the
ECU. Adjust throttle cable freeplay (ETC switch) and
make sure throttle mechanism is functioning
properly before testing the switch. Refer to A
Maintenance Chapter 2 for cable adjustment
procedure.
10.18
ELECTRICAL
IGNITION SYSTEM
Flywheel Identification
The flywheel can be identified by the stamp mark in location A. Refer to I.D." location in chart below. Do not use the cast mark
to determine flywheel application.
Kokusan Flywheel
Timing
Marks
Production Date
A Part Number
NOTE: DC/CDI systems and components are not interchangeable with any other system.
Typical Timing Curve Display
10
10.19
ELECTRICAL
Alternator/Ignition Components - 700/800 EFI
Ignition Coils
Battery to Solenoid Cable
Starter Solenoid
Cable
Relays
Voltage Regulator
Stator Assembly
Flywheel
10.20
ELECTRICAL
Crankshaft Position Sensor Gap CHARGING SYSTEM
Measure trigger coil gap with a feeler gauge. The gap should be
.059 inch (1.0 mm). Current Draw - Key Off
CAUTION
10.21
ELECTRICAL
Charging System Break Even Test Alternator Output Test
Three tests can be performed using a multimeter to determine
CAUTION the condition of the stator (alternator).
WARNING
10.22
ELECTRICAL
TEST 2: Resistance Value of Stator Leg to Ground
1. Measure the resistance value of each of the stator legs to
ground: Y1 to Ground, Y2 to Ground, Y3 to Ground.
NOTE: Any measurement other than Infinity (open)
will indicate a failed or shorted stator leg.
AC VOLTAGE (VAC )
ATV RPM READING
READING
10
10.23
ELECTRICAL
Charging System Testing Flow Chart
Whenever charging system problems are suspected, proceed with the following system check after verifying that all wires are in good
condition, connected and not kinked or pinched.
No
Yes
Yes
10.24
ELECTRICAL
RELAYS POWER RELAY
The relays, located next to the ECU, assist with component KEY-ON Battery power supply, switched
operation such as the fan, fuel pump, etc. on by the key and LH control switches,
Red/White
enables power to relay. Tied to Fan Relay
The fan relay, controlled by the ECU, operates the fan.
terminal.
The power relay, controlled by the ECU, turns on power for
components such as the fuel pump, injectors, etc. Relay ON command. The ECU supplies a
Gray/White ground which closes the relay, supplying
The differential relay, controlled by the AWD switch and ECU, power to run the fuel pump, injectors, etc.
operates the differential solenoid.
Fused 15-amp, unswitched battery power
Orange
IN supply for EFI component operation.
EFI power output. 'ON' when ECU sends a
signal on the GRY/W wire, closing the
Red/Black
relay. Supplies 15-amp power for ECU-
controlled operation of EFI components.
FAN RELAY
COLOR FUNCTION
10.25
ELECTRICAL
FUSES/CIRCUIT BREAKER LIGHTING
Operation High Beam Headlight Bulb Replacement
The fuse panel, located next to the ECU, assist with component
protection such as the Instrument Cluster/ECU, EFI system,
Chassis Power and Accessories.
A 20-amp circuit breaker protects the fan circuit. Remove 3 Screws
CAUTION
A B
10.26
ELECTRICAL
4. Turn the headlight lamp socket counter-clockwise and 3. Unplug headlamp harness (C).
remove.
C
Loosen Tighten
10
10.27
ELECTRICAL
8. Reverse the steps to install the new housing and reassemble 1. Place the vehicle on a level surface with the headlight
the pod. approximately 25' (7.6 m) from a wall.
25 (7.6 m)
Lamp Center Height
2 (5.1 cm)
Loosen Tighten
10.28
ELECTRICAL
2. Pull the harness assembly out from the headlight assembly. Low Beam Headlight Adjustment
1. The low beam can be adjusted slightly upward or
downward.
Loosen Screw
Yellow
Remove Screw
Upper Headlamp Plug Wires
Brown
Green
10
10.29
ELECTRICAL
Sportsman Work Light Switch (Deluxe) Sportsman Brake Light / Work Light (Deluxe)
Replacement
Remove the headlight pod cover to locate the switch wires. The
switch snaps out by pushing in on the tabs on both sides of the The brake light (A) and the work light (B) are both located in the
switch. rear tail lamp housing.
A B
A
Brown
Blue
10.30
ELECTRICAL
2. To remove the brake light electrical connector (B), press in X2 BRAKE LIGHT / WORK LIGHT (Deluxe)
on the tab on the connector to unlock the connector and pull REPLACEMENT
the connector from the bulb assembly.
The brake light (A) and the work light (B) are both located in the
rear tail lamp housing.
1. Open the tailgate and remove the 2 torx head screws (A)
securing the rear taillights on each side of the cargo box as
illustrated below.
A
A
CAUTION
10.31
ELECTRICAL
3. Carefully pull out the red locking tab on the connector. Brake Light Switch
1. Remove the front cover.
4. Once the red tab is pulled out, press in on the black tab and
pull out to disconnect harness.
Black Tab
Red Tab
Brake Switch
5. Disconnect the two wire harnesses connected to each of the Location
taillights. Twist bulb housing to remove from lamp
assembly.
2. Disconnect wire harness from switch.
3. Connect an ohmmeter across switch contacts. Reading
should be infinite ().
4. Apply brake at handlebar lever and check for continuity
between switch contacts. Replace switch if there is no
continuity or greater than .5 ohms resistance when the brake
is applied with slight pressure.
Install Remove
10.32
ELECTRICAL
FUEL SENDER X2 DIFFERENTIAL SYSTEM
Testing Solenoid Testing
1. Drain the fuel tank and remove it from the atv. Disconnect from the wire harness. Using a digital ohmmeter,
2. Set the fuel tank on a flat surface. test the solenoid at the connector leads and compare to the
specification. Replacement of solenoid is required as it is not
3. Hook up an ohm meter to the fuel sender harness Violet/ serviceable.
White wire (B) and Brown wire (C).
4. With the sender float in the empty position and compare
to specification.
5. Slowly tilt invert the tank so that gravity moves the sender
float to the full position and compare to specification.
Fuel Sender
Empty: 5 5%
Half: 57 5%
Full: 90 5% Differential Solenoid Resistance:
1.45 5 %
10.33
ELECTRICAL
Differential Relay Operation X2 SPEED SENSOR
The AWD switch must be turned to TURF mode.
Testing
Speed must be below 15mph and transmission must not
be in Park. Using the special tools listed, test the speed sensor according to
the tester instructions. Remove sensor and inspect the o-ring
12Vdc is constant at the differential relay. seal for damage or wear and replace as required. Replacement
of sensor is required as it is not serviceable.
ECU senses grounding on pin #26 from the AWD
switch.
ECU grounds pin #13, activating the relay.
Relay powers the differential solenoid.
System must be grounded to operate.
Replacement
1. Remove the sensor retaining using a suitable tool.
2. Coat o-ring of new sensor with anti-seize compound or
sealant.
3. Push new sensor into gearcase housing. Install bolt and
tighten to specification.
=T
Speed Sensor Bolt Torque
8-12 ft. lbs. (11-17 Nm)
10.34
ELECTRICAL
ACCESSORY POWER NOTE: Refer to the accessory instructions for
accessory hook-up and installation.
Wire Connections
Winch Installation Orange/White Wires Located In This Area
The Sportsman models have the main winch cables routed and
installed from the factory. This enables quick installation.
Refer to Chapter 2 for more information on winch installation
and operation.
Accessory Power Wires
The accessory power leads for all accessories are located under
the front cover. The wires are 12 Volt wires and are Orange /
White in color. To locate the wires, remove the front cover. The
wires will be located in the main wire loom on the right side.
If you have trouble locating the Orange / White wires remove
the left side panel and search under the front fender area.
Orange/White Wires
Accessory Wires
Power Point
Acc #1
(Located
Below Head
Lamps)
10
Acc. 2
10.35
ELECTRICAL
STARTER SYSTEM
700/800 Starter Lockout Overview and Diagnostic
The Sportsman 700/800 and International EFI starter lockout is controlled by the ECU. Pin #20 senses the transmission signal and
determines if the switch is in Neutral or Park. Pin #24 senses when the brake is applied. When the conditions are met, the ECU will
activate Pin #16 to ground the starter solenoid. Note the ground for the transmission switch runs to the wire harness splice. The ECU
will allow starting in Neutral or Park without the brake applied. Applying the brake overrides this system and allows starting
regardless of transmission shift position.
Items to check when diagnosing a no-start condition are:
Transmission switch for proper function
Starter solenoid for proper function
Brake switch for proper function
Wire harness, loose connections/pins (including the ECU) leading to and from these components
Proper ground to frame
Should all these items be found in working order, the ECU may be at fault.
5P'SBNF(SPVOE
5P4UBSUFS4PMFOPJE
5P3%8)4QMJDF
10.36
ELECTRICAL
800 X2 Starter Lockout Overview and Diagnostic
The Sportsman 800 X2 EFI starter lockout is controlled by the ECU. Pin #20 senses the transmission signal and determines if the
switch is in Neutral or Park. Pin #24 senses when the brake is applied. When the conditions are met, the ECU will activate Pin #16
to ground the starter solenoid. Note the ground for the transmission switch runs to the wire harness splice. The ECU will allow starting
in Neutral or Park without the brake applied. Applying the brake overrides this system and allows starting regardless of transmission
shift position.
Items to check when diagnosing a no-start condition are:
Transmission switch for proper function
Starter solenoid for proper function
Brake switch for proper function
Wire harness, loose connections/pins (including the ECU) leading to and from these components
Proper ground to frame
Should all these items be found in working order, the ECU may be at fault.
5P4UBSUFS4PMFOPJE
5P3%8)4QMJDF
10
10.37
ELECTRICAL
Troubleshooting Starter Motor Removal / Disassembly
Starter Motor Does Not Run NOTE: Use electrical contact cleaner to clean starter
motor parts. Some solvents may leave a residue or
Battery discharged - Low specific gravity damage internal parts and insulation.
Loose or faulty battery cables or corroded connections
(see Voltage Drop Tests)
Related wiring loose, disconnected, or corroded
Poor ground connections at battery cable, starter motor
or starter solenoid (see Voltage Drop Tests)
Faulty key switch
Faulty kill switch
Faulty starter lockout function
Faulty starter solenoid or starter motor
Engine problem - seized or binding (Can engine be
rotated easily?)
Starter Motor Turns Over Slowly
Battery discharged - low specific gravity 1. Remove the starter from the engine.
Excessive circuit resistance - poor connections (see 2. Remove the two bolts, washers, and sealing O-Rings.
Voltage Drop Test) Inspect O-Rings and replace if damaged.
Engine problem - seized or binding (Can engine be
rotated easily?)
Faulty or worn brushes in starter motor
Starter Motor Turns - Engine Does Not Rotate
Faulty starter drive
Faulty starter drive gears or starter motor gear
Faulty flywheel gear or loose flywheel
10.38
ELECTRICAL
3. Remove the front bracket assembly and the rear bracket 2. Measure resistance between insulated brush and starter
assembly. Remove the shims from the armature shaft and housing. Reading should be infinite. (OL). Inspect
inspect the O-rings located on the armature housing. insulation on brush wires for damage and repair or replace
as necessary.
O-Rings
Shims
NOTE: The shims will be replaced during 3. Slide positive brush springs to the side, pull brushes out of
reassembly. their guides and remove brush plate. Slide brush end frame
off end of starter.
BRUSH INSPECTION / REPLACEMENT NOTE: The electrical input post must stay with the
1. Measure resistance between starter input terminal and field coil housing.
insulated brushes. The reading should be .3 ohms or less.
4. Measure resistance between ground brush and brush plate.
Remember to subtract meter lead resistance.
Resistance should be .3 ohms or less.
Brush Inspection
1. Measure length of each carbon brush. Replace brush
10
assembly when worn to 5/16 (8 mm) or less. The brushes
must slide freely in their holders.
Brush Length
10.39
ELECTRICAL
Brush Replacement 4. Measure the resistance between each commutator segment
and the armature shaft. The reading should be infinite (no
1. Remove terminal nut with lock washer, flat washer, large continuity).
phenolic washer, the small phenolic spacers, and sealing
O-ring. Inspect O-ring and replace if damaged.
CAUTION
Some cleaning solvents may damage the insulation 5. Check commutator bars for discoloration. Bars discolored
in the starter. Care should be exercised when in pairs indicate shorted coils, requiring replacement of the
selecting an appropriate solvent. If the commutator starter motor.
needs cleaning use only electrical contact cleaner. 6. Place armature in a growler. Turn growler on and position
a hacksaw blade or feeler gauge lengthwise 1/8 (.3 cm)
Armature Testing above armature coil laminates. Rotate armature 360. If
hacksaw blade is drawn to armature on any pole, the
1. Remove armature from starter casing. Note order of shims armature is shorted and must be replaced.
on drive end for reassembly.
CAUTION
10.40
ELECTRICAL
Starter Reassembly / Installation 9. Lightly grease pinion shaft and install pinion, spring
stopper, and snap ring.
1. Install brush plate to field magnet housing aligning index
tab.
10. Install the starter onto the engine case. Hand tighten each
of the starter bolts. Torque the bottom bolt first to 9
2. Install O-ring, two small phenolic spacers, large phenolic ft.lbs. (12 Nm). Then torque the top bolt to the same
washer, flat washer, lock washer, and terminal nut. specification.
3. While holding brush springs away from brushes, push NOTE: It is important to tighten the bottom starter
brushes back and hold in place. bolt first (circle), as the bottom hole acts as a pilot
4. Slide armature into field magnet housing. Release brushes. hole to properly align the starter drive (bendix) with
5. Lightly grease the drive roller bearing and reinstall drive the flywheel. This helps to prevent binding and
end frame on armature. Inspect seal for wear or damage. starter damage.
Replace drive end cap if necessary.
Roller Bearing
Seal
10.41
ELECTRICAL
Starter Drive
Pinion Gear - Anti-kick Out Shoe, Garter Spring Replacement
If the garter spring is damaged, the overrun clutch may fail to return properly. Use either of the following methods to remove and
install a new garter spring:
H
G
A F
D
A. Gear Assembly E
B. Thrust Washer C
C. Busing
D. Retaining Ring
E. Thrust Washer
F. Stopper
G. Cover
H. Spring
1. Screw the overrun clutch out to the engaged position on the pinion shaft assembly. Use a small piece of wire with the end bent
in a hook and pick the old spring out of its channel. Slide it off the end of the shaft. Slide the new spring over the overrun
clutch and into the spring groove. Make sure that the spring is positioned between the shoe alignment pins and the back flange
of the anti kick-out shoes.
2. Remove the retaining ring, thrust washer, spring retainers and clutch return spring. Screw the overrun clutch off the end of the
pinion shaft. Remove the old spring and install a new one. Lightly grease the pinion shaft and reinstall the clutch, spring,
retainers, end washer and lock ring in the reverse order. Make sure the end washer is positioned properly so that it will hold
the lock ring in its groove.
10.42
ELECTRICAL
Starter Exploded View
10.43
ELECTRICAL
STARTER SYSTEM TESTING FLOW CHART
Condition: Starter fails to turn motor. NOTE: Make sure engine crankshaft is free to turn
before proceeding with dynamic testing of starter system. A digital multitester must be used
for this test
With the tester on the VDC position, place the
tester's black lead on the battery negative and the
red lead on the battery positive. Reading should Remove battery and properly service. Install
be 12.4 V D. C. or greater. No fully charged shop battery to continue test.
Yes
Disconnect coil engagement wire from the starter Check voltage on both sides of circuit
solenoid. Connect tester black wire to battery breaker, ignition switch/engine stop switch
ground. Connect red tester lead to harness wire at and starter button. The voltage on both sides
solenoid. Turn on ignition switch and depress the No should be the same. NOTE: The ignition
starter button. Tester should read battery voltage. switch and engine stop switch must be on and
the starter button depressed. Replace
component if failed .
Reconnect the solenoid. Connect the tester black No Clean the battery-to-solenoid cable ends
lead to the battery positive and the red lead to the or replace the cable.
solenoid end of the battery-to-solenoid wire.
Depress starter button. Reading should be less
than .1 V D.C.
Yes
Yes
Yes
If all of these indicate a good condition, yet the starter still fails to
turn, the starter must be removed for static testing and inspection.
10.44
ELECTRICAL
BASIC WINCH WIRING- PRE-WIRED MODELS
10
10.45
ELECTRICAL
BATTERY Battery Activation (Conventional)
Battery Identification
WARNING
NOTE: It is important to identify what type of battery
you have installed in your ATV. Different types of Battery electrolyte is poisonous. It contains sulfuric
batteries require different service procedures. acid. Serious burns can result from contact with
Proper servicing and upkeep of your battery is very skin, eyes or clothing. Antidote:
important for maintaining long battery life.
External: Flush with water.
Your ATV may have a Conventional Battery or a Sealed Low
Maintenance Battery. To identify which type of battery your
ATV has, refer to the illustration below and follow the correct Internal: Drink large quantities of water or milk.
service and charging procedures that follow in the manual. Follow with milk of magnesia, beaten egg, or
vegetable oil. Call physician immediately.
Conventional Battery
Eyes: Flush with water for 15 minutes and get
Removable prompt medical attention.
Caps
Batteries produce explosive gases. Keep sparks,
flame, cigarettes, etc. away. Ventilate when
charging or using in an enclosed space. Always
Top View shield eyes when working near batteries. KEEP
OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
Electrolyte Level
Indicator WARNING
10.46
ELECTRICAL
4. Add electrolyte to bring level back to upper level mark on Inspect the battery fluid level. When the battery fluid nears the
case. lower level, remove the battery and fill with distilled water only
to the upper level line. To remove the battery:
NOTE: This is the last time that electrolyte should
be added. If the level becomes low after this point,
add only distilled water.
Battery Terminals/Bolts
Terminal Preparation
Use Polaris corrosion resistant Nyogel grease (PN 2871329)
on battery bolts and terminals when installing a battery. This
will help to prevent corrosion and maintain good electrical
connection. See BATTERY INSTALLATION. 1. Disconnect holder strap and remove covers.
2. Disconnect battery negative (-) (black) cable first, followed
Conventional Battery Inspection / Removal by the positive (+) (red) cable.
The battery is located under the seat on Sportsman models.
CAUTION
10.47
ELECTRICAL
4. Install clear battery vent tube from vehicle to battery vent.
WARNING
* Measurement at 80 F
NOTE: Subtract .01 from the specific gravity reading
at 40 F
10.48
ELECTRICAL
Battery Load Test NOTE: Recharge to full capacity every 30 to 60 days
during a non-use period. If the battery is stored
during the winter months, electrolyte will freeze at
CAUTION higher temperatures as the battery discharges. The
chart below indicates freezing points by specific
To prevent shock or component damage, remove gravity.
spark plug high tension leads and connect securely
to engine ground before proceeding. ELECTROLYTE FREEZING POINTS
10
10.49
ELECTRICAL
6. Install clear battery vent tube from vehicle to battery vent. NEW BATTERIES: Batteries must be fully charged before
use or battery life can be reduced by 10-30% of full potential.
Charge battery for 3-5 hours using a variable rate charger. Do
WARNING not use the alternator to charge a new battery. A high rate battery
charger can cause battery damage.
Vent tube must be free from obstructions and kinks Low Maintenance batteries are permanently sealed at the time of
and securely installed. If not, battery gases could manufacture. The use of lead-calcium and AGM technology
accumulate and cause an explosion. Vent should instead of lead-antimony allows the battery acid to be fully
absorbed. For this reason, a Low Maintenance battery case is
be routed away from frame and body to prevent dark and the cell caps are not removable, since there is no need
contact with electrolyte. Avoid skin contact with to check electrolyte level.
electrolyte, as severe burns could result.
If electrolyte contacts the vehicle frame, NEVER attempt to add electrolyte or water to a Low
Maintenance battery. Doing so will damage the case and shorten
corrosion will occur. the life of the battery. Refer to the Battery Activation and
Maintenance Video (PN 9917987) for proper instruction on
7. Route cables so they are tucked away in front and behind servicing Low Maintenance batteries.
battery.
NOTE: New Batteries: Batteries must be fully
charged before use or battery life will be reduced by
Low Maintenance Battery 10-30% of full potential. Charge battery for 3-5 hours
Battery Check: at a current equivalent of 1/10 of the battery's rated
amp/hour capacity. Do not use the alternator to
NOTE: All Low Maintenance batteries are fully charge a new battery. (Refer to Battery Activation
charged and tested at the factory before installation. and Maintenance video PN 9917987)
Expected shelf life varies on storage conditions. As
a general rule before placing the battery into service, NEVER attempt to add electrolyte or water to a Low
check the battery condition and charge accordingly. Maintenance battery. Doing so will damage the case and shorten
the life of the battery. Refer to the Battery Maintenance Video
(PN 9917987) for proper instruction on servicing Low
1. Check the date label on the side of the battery to calculate Maintenance batteries.
when to check voltage. The battery should be checked
every 3 months. TO SERVICE A LOW MAINTENANCE BATTERY:
2. Check the voltage with a voltmeter or multimeter. A fully 1. Remove battery from the vehicle.
charged battery should be 12.8 V or higher. 2. Test battery with a voltage meter or load tester to determine
3. If the voltage is below 12.8 V, the battery will need to be battery condition. This will determine the length of time
recharged. required to charge the battery to full capacity. Refer to
capacity table.
3. Charge battery using a variable rate charger.
WARNING
10.50
ELECTRICAL
BATTERY CHARGING REFERENCE TABLE The X2 battery is located under fuel tank and can be accessed by
removing the right hand side panel.
STATE OF CHARGE
VOLTAGE ACTION
CHARGE TIME
None, check
voltage at 3 mos. None
100% 12.8-13 V
after manufacture Required
date
May need slight
75-100% 12.5-12.8 V 3-6 Hours
charge BATTERY
50-75% 12.0-12.5 V Needs Charge 5-11 Hours
At least 13
hours, verify
25-50% 11.5-12.0 V Needs Charge
state of
charge
11.5 V At least 20 1. Remove the seat and Disconnect holder strap.
0-25% Needs Charge
or less hours 2. Disconnect battery negative (-) (black) cable first, followed
by the positive (+) (red) cable.
Low Maintenance Battery Inspection /
Removal CAUTION
The battery is located under the seat on Sportsman models.
Whenever removing or reinstalling the battery,
disconnect the negative (black) cable first and
reinstall the negative cable last!
10
10.51
ELECTRICAL
Low Maintenance Battery - OCV- Open Low Maintenance Battery Load Test
Circuit Voltage Test
Battery voltage should be checked with a digital multitester.
Readings of 12.8 volts or less require further battery testing and
CAUTION
charging. See charts and Load Test.
To prevent shock or component damage, remove
NOTE: Lead-acid batteries should be kept at or near spark plug high tension leads and connect securely
a full charge as possible. If the battery is stored or to engine ground before proceeding.
used in a partially charged condition, or with low
electrolyte levels, hard crystal sulfation will form on NOTE: This test can only be performed on machines
the plates, reducing the efficiency and service life of with electric starters. This test cannot be performed
the battery. with an engine or starting system that is not working
properly.
NOTE: Use a voltmeter or multimeter to test battery
voltage. A battery may indicate a full charge condition in the OCV test
and the specific gravity test, but still may not have the storage
OPEN CIRCUIT VOLTAGE capacity necessary to properly function in the electrical system.
For this reason, a battery capacity or load test should be
conducted whenever poor battery performance is encountered.
STATE OF LOW MAINTENANCE CONVENTIONAL To perform this test:
CHARGE BATTERY BATTERY
1. Hook a multitester to the battery in the same manner as was
100 % 13.0V 12.70V done in the OCV test. The reading should be 12.8 volts or
greater.
75% Charged 12.80V 12.50V
2. Engage the starter and observe the battery voltage while
50% 12.50V 12.20V cranking the engine. Continue the test for 15 seconds.
25% 12.20V 12.0V 3. During cranking the observed voltage should not drop
below 9.5 volts.
0% Charged less than 12.0V less than 11.9V 4. If the beginning voltage is 12.8 volts or higher and the
cranking voltage drops below 9.5 volts during the test,
* Measurement at 80 F replace the battery.
10.52
ELECTRICAL
Low Maintenance Battery Off-season Low Maintenance Battery Charging
Storage Procedure
Battery voltage should be checked with a digital multitester. 1. Remove the battery from the ATV to prevent damage from
Readings of 12.8 volts or less require further battery testing and leaking or spilled acid during charging.
charging. See charts and Load Test.
2. Charge the battery with a variable rate charging output.
Remove the battery from the machine and wash the Charge as needed to raise the specific gravity to 1.270 or
case and battery tray with a mild solution of baking greater.
soda and water. Rinse with lots of fresh water after
cleaning. 3. Install battery in vehicle with positive terminal toward the
front. Coat threads of battery bolt with a corrosion resistant
Using a wire brush or knife, remove any corrosion from Nyogel Grease (PN 2871329).
the cables and terminals.
4. Route cables so they are tucked away in front and behind
Make sure that the electrolyte is at the proper level. battery.
Charge at a rate no greater than 1/10 of the battery's 5. Connect battery cables.
amp/hr capacity until the electrolyte's specific gravity
reaches 1.270 or greater.
WARNING
Store the battery either in the machine with the cables
disconnected, or store in a cool place.
To avoid the possibility of sparks and explosion,
NOTE: Stored batteries lose their charge at the rate connect positive (red) cable first and negative
of 1% per day. Recharge to full capacity every 30 to (black) cable last.
60 days during a non-use period. If the battery is
stored during the winter months, electrolyte will 6. After connecting the battery cables, install the cover on the
freeze at higher temperatures as the battery battery and attach the hold down strap.
discharges. The chart below indicates freezing
points by specific gravity.
1.265 -75 F
1.225 -35 F
1.200 -17 F
1.150 +5 F
1.100 +18 F
1.050 +27 F
10
10.53
ELECTRICAL
NOTES
10.54
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
CHAPTER 11
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.2
OVERVIEW. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.2
EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL STEERING POST AND LOCK ASSEMBLY. . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.4
STEERING ASSEMBLY EXPLODED VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.4
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL ELECTRICAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.5
TURN / HAZARD SIGNAL DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.5
NOTE: This chapter illustrates components that are unique to the Sportsman 800 EFI International.
Except where noted, any servicing of these components or other components
on the ATV can be done using this service manuals procedures and illustrations.
11
11.1
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL BRAKE SYSTEM
Overview
The Sportsman International brake system consists of a complete hydraulic brake system. All-wheel braking is integrated into the
foot brake and hand brake systems and allows 4 wheel braking from either control separately, or at the same time.
When the foot brake is applied, all brake calipers are active, as braking pressure is routed from the foot brake master cylinder through
the proportioning valve and distribution block, exiting one line to the front calipers, while the other line exits the proportioning valve
and feeds the outer line to the rear calipers.
When the hand brake is applied, all brake calipers are active, as braking pressure is routed from the hand brake master cylinder
through the distribution block, exiting one line to the front calipers, while the other line feeds the inner line to the rear calipers.
11.2
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
Exploded View
11
11.3
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL STEERING POST AND LOCK ASSEMBLY
Steering Assembly Exploded View
The 800 EFI International Sportsman is equipped with a locking mechanism to prevent theft or unauthorized use. Steering post
removal may be required for lock service or repair.
Lock System Item Number / Description:
11. Lock Collar
12. Lock Set
13. Bolt, Lock Set
14. Bolt(s), Lock Collar
15. Nut(s), Lock Collar
11.4
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL ELECTRICAL
Turn / Hazard Signal Diagram
11
11.5
800 EFI INTERNATIONAL
NOTES
11.6
A Brake System Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26
A-Arm Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.18
Accessory Power Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.35
Brake System Overview, International . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.2
Brake, Master Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.9 IX
Brake, Rear Auxiliary Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.28
Active Descent Control (ADC) Coil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15
Brake, Rear Auxiliary Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.26
Active Descent Control Gearcase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.22
Brake, Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.2
ADC Gearcase Piston Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.27
Brakes, Operation Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6
ADC Gearcase, Disassembly / Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . 7.23
Brakes, Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.29
ADC reservoir level inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.17
Air Box Sediment Tube . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.21 C
Air Filter Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20 Cam Gear, Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.37
All Wheel Drive (AWD) Coil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.15 Cam Gear, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.36
Alternator / Ignition Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.20 Camber / Caster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
Alternator Output Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.22 Cargo Box, Removal and Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.26
Auxiliary (Rear) Brake Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27 Charging Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
Auxiliary Brake Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28 Charging System - Break Even Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.22
B Charging System Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.24
Circuit Breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26
Balance Shaft Gear, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.38
Ball Joint Replacement, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.19 Cleaning and Storage of ATV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.33
Battery Activation, Conventional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.46 Clock, Setting Time of Day . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.4
Clutch Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.14
Battery Charging Procedure, Low Maintenance . . . . . 10.53
Clutch Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.14
Battery Inspection / Removal, Low Maintenance . . . . 10.51
Clutch, Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.36
Battery Installation, Low Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.51
Combustion Chamber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.26
Battery Load Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
Component Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8
Battery Load Test, Low Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.52
Component Locations, Sportsman . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.7
Battery Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
Compression Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16
Battery Off Season Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.49
Conversion Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.14
Battery Off Season Storage, Low Maintenance . . . . . . 10.53
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.18
Battery Open Circuit Voltage (OCV), Low Maintenance . . .
Cooling System - Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
10.52
Battery Removal / Inspection, Conventional . . . . . . . . 10.47 Cooling System - Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
Cooling System - Radiator Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.20
Battery Terminals/Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.47
Cooling System Bleeding Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15
Body and Steering Torque Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
Cooling System Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
Body Assembly Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.12, 5.13
Cooling System Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
Body Rack Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.14
Cooling System, Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.15
Brake Bleeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
Crank Position Sensor Gap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
Brake Burnishing Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12
Crankshaft Gear, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.38
Brake Caliper Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5
Crankshaft Position Sensor (CPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.14
Brake Caliper Removal, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.21, 9.23
Current Draw - Key Off Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
Brake Caliper, Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.24
CV Boot, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
Brake Caliper, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.14
CV Shaft Boot Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Brake Disc, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.12
Cylinder Head Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.28
Brake Disc, Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.25
Cylinder Head Assembly Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . 3.21
Brake Hose Fitting Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27
Cylinder Head Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.24
Brake Light / Work Light Switch Replacement 10.30, 10.31
Cylinder Honing To De-glaze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.19
Brake Light Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.32
Cylinder Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.31
Brake Noise Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.7
Brake Pad Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.27 D
Brake Pad Install, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.20 Decal Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
Brake Pad Removal, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.19 Diagnostic Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.7
Brake Pad, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.17 Diagnostic Mode, EFI System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.7
Brake Pad, Removal and Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.10 Diagnostic Mode, Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.4
Brake System Components, Std, Sportsman . . . . . . . . . . 9.4 Differential Solenoid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33
Brake System Components, X2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3 Drive Belt, Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.13
Brake System Exploded View, International . . . . . . . . . 11.3 Drive Belt, Removal/Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.12
Brake System Exploded Views . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3 Drive Clutch Springs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8
IX.1
Drive Clutch Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.9 Engine Piston Removal, Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.30
Drive Clutch, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.6 Engine Piston Ring Installed Gap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.33
Drive Clutch, Standard Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.28 Engine Piston to Cylinder Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
Drive Shaft Boot Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.4 Engine Piston to Rod Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
Driven Clutch, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.6 Engine Pushrod Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.22
Driven Clutch, Standard Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.34 Engine Removal / Install Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.16
E Engine Rocker Arm Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.22
Engine Service Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.11
EBS Drive Clutch Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.15
Engine Starter Drive Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.33
EBS Driven Clutch Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.22
Engine Starter Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.35
EBS Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.4, 6.5
Engine Stator Gear Cover Seal(s) Installation . . . . . . . . 3.50
EBS, Driven Clutch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.7
Engine Stator Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.52
EFI Diagnostic Mode Using Instrument Cluster . . . . . . .10.7
Engine Temperature Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
EFI Operation Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.7
Engine Temperature Sensor Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
EFI Priming / Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.7
Engine Temperature Sensor Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.18
EFI Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.20
Engine Torque Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.10
Electronic Control Unit (ECU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.8
Engine Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.57
Engine Balance Shaft Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.42
Engine Valve Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.25
Engine Breather Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.21
Engine Valve Lifter Removal, Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . 3.29
Engine Camshaft Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.42
Engine Valve Seal/Spring Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.23
Engine Camshaft Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.44
Engine Valve Sealing Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.29
Engine Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14, 3.15
Engine Valve Seat Reconditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.26
Engine Cooling System Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . .3.58
Engine, Accessible Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.14
Engine Crankcase Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.43
ETC Operation Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
Engine Crankshaft Gear Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.39
ETC Switch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.18
Engine Crankshaft Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.44
Exhaust Breakdown, Sportsman 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . 3.59
Engine Cylinder Head Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.28
Exhaust Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.26
Engine Cylinder Head Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.23
Exhaust, 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.35
Engine Cylinder Head Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.22
Exhaust, Dual 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.59
Engine Cylinder Head Warp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.23
Engine Cylinder Honing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.18 F
Engine Cylinder Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.31 Fan Control Circuit Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Engine Cylinder Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.45 Fan Control Circuit Operation / Testing . . . . . . . . . . . 10.16
Engine Cylinder Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.29 Fan Motor Current Draw . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.17
Engine Diagnostic Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.19 Final Drive Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
Engine Exploded Views . . . . . . . 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.7, 3.8 Flywheel / Stator Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.34
Engine Fastener Torques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.9 Flywheel ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.19
Engine Flywheel / Stator Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.54 Flywheel, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.34
Engine Flywheel / Stator Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.34 Foot Well Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.5
Engine Flywheel Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.35 Frame, Nuts, Bolts Fastener Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30
Engine Gear(s) Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.36 Front Cab Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.9
Engine Gears, Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.48 Front Cover Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4
Engine Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.22 Front Drive Axle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4
Engine Head Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.55 Front Drive Axle Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
Engine Installation Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.18 Front Gearcase - Back Lash Pad Adjustment . . . . . . . . 7.18
Engine Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.20 Front Gearcase Coil Resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.14, 7.23
Engine Mount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.17 Front Gearcase Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.12
Engine Oil and Filter Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.23 Front Gearcase, Active Descent Control Exploded View 7.21
Engine Oil Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.20 Front Gearcase, Diagnoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.19
Engine Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.22 Front Gearcase, Disassembly / Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . 7.13
Engine Oil Pressure Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.20 Front Gearcase, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.11
Engine Oil Priming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.53 Front Gearcase, Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.20
Engine Oil Pump Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.46 Front Gearcase, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.11
Engine Oil Pump Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.39 Front Gearcase, Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.29
Engine Piston Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.14 Front Gearcase, Reassembly / Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . 7.17
Engine Piston Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.45 Front Gearcase, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.12
IX.2
Front Hub, Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6 Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
Front Hub, Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6
Front Storage Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.8
Model Number/VIN Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2
O IX
Front Storage Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.6
Oil Pump, Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.39
Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16, 4.12
Oil Pump, Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.40
Fuel Injection, Component Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5
Oil Pump, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.39
Fuel Injection, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4
Fuel Injection, Service Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 P
Fuel Injection, Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Paint Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3
Fuel Injector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.13 Passenger Seat, Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.29
Fuel Pressure Regulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.12 Piston Ring Installed Gap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.33
Fuel Pump / Tank Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.9 Piston to Cylinder Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
Fuel Sender Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.33 Piston to Rod Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.32
Fuel System, EFI Circuit Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.21 Plastic Inserts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3
Fuel Tank Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6 Pre-ride Checklist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.10
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26 Propshaft, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
G Publication Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3
PVT Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.11
Gear / Stator Housing Seal Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.49 PVT Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.10
Gear Position Indicator Switch Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.17 PVT Drive Clutch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
Gearcase, ADC Hydraulic Fluid Change . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.14
PVT Drive Clutch Shift Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.9
Gearcase, Front Capacity and Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
PVT Drive Clutch Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.8
Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.15
PVT Driven Clutch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
H PVT Drying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.22, 6.10
Handlebar Block Installation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.16 PVT Ducting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
Headlamp Switch Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.29 PVT Maintenance / Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7
Headlight Housing Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.27 PVT Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6
Headlight Pod Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.15 PVT Overheating Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.36
High Beam Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.26 PVT Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
High Beam Headlight Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.28 PVT Torque Specs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.2
Hydraulic Brake System Operation Overview . . . . . . . . . 9.6 PVT Troubleshooting Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.37
I PVT, Button to Tower Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.17, 6.30
PVT, Clutch Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.14
Ignition Curve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.19
PVT, Clutch Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.14
Ignition System Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.21
PVT, Drive Belt Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.13
Instrument Cluster (Speedometer) Overview . . . . . . . . . 10.3
PVT, Drive Belt Removal/Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.12
Instrument Cluster, Setting New Service Interval . . . . . 10.6
PVT, Drive Clutch Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.15, 6.28
Interlock, Starter, 700/800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.36
PVT, Drive Clutch Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.3
Interlock, Starter, 800 X2 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.37
PVT, Drive Clutch Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.20, 6.32
K PVT, Drive Clutch Spider Removal . . . . . . . . . . . 6.15, 6.29
Keys, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.3 PVT, Driven Clutch Bushing Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.24
L PVT, Driven Clutch Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.22
Low Beam Headlight Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.29 PVT, Driven Clutch Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.25
Low Maintenance Battery Charging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.50 PVT, EBS Clutch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.7
Low Maintenance Battery Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.50 PVT, EBS Drive Clutch Bushing Service . . . . . . . 6.18, 6.31
Lower Headlamp Housing Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.29 PVT, EBS Drive Clutch Cover Bushing Remove/Install 6.19,
Lower Headlamp Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.28 6.32
Lubricants/Fluids, Polaris Brand Part Numbers . . . . . . . . 2.9 PVT, Moveable Sheave Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.18, 6.31
Lubricants/Fluids, Polaris Brand Symbol Identification Chart R
2.10 Radiator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.19
Lubrication / Grease Points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.11 Radiator Screen Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.11
M Rear Cab Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.10
Maintenance Chart, Periodic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Rear Gearcase, Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.41
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.36 Rear Gearcase, Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.39
Misc. Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.12 Rear Gearcase, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.43
IX.3
Rear Gearcase, Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.42 Specifications, Engine Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.20
Rear Gearcase, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.39 Specifications, Engine Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.20
Rear Master Cylinder, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9.26 Specifications, Final Drive Torque Values . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2
Rear Rack Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.8 Specifications, Front Gearcase Lubrication Type/Capacity 7.2
Rear Storage Removal / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.11 Specifications, Oil Baffle Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.43
Rear Suspension Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.22, 5.23 Specifications, Oil Pick-up Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.43
Relays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.25 Specifications, Sportsman 700 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.6
S Specifications, Sportsman 800 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8
Specifications, Sportsman 800 X2 EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.10
See FRONT GEARCASE - CENTRALIZED HILLIARD
Speed Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
(STANDARD on page 7.10. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.23
Speedometer Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.9
Service Intervals, Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.6
Speedometer Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.8
Shift Linkage Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.14
Speedometer Sensor, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.34
Side Panel Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.4
Speedometer Troubleshooting Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.10
Solenoid, Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.33
Speedometer, Funtions Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.3
Spark Plug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.17
Starter Armature Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.40
Special Tool, Cam Gear Installation Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.37
Starter Assembly Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.43
Special Tools, Body & Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5.2
Starter Brush Inspection / Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.39
Special Tools, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.13
Starter Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.42
Special Tools, Final Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7.2
Starter Drive Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.33
Special Tools, Speed Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.34
Starter Interlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10.36, 10.37
Specific Gravity Test, Conventional Battery . . . . . . . .10.48
Starter Motor, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
Specification, Balance Shaft Gear Bolt Torque . . . . . . .3.48
Starter Reassembly / Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.41
Specification, Brake Disc Service Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . .9.25
Starter System Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.44
Specification, Brake Disc Thickness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9.25
Starter System, Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
Specification, Brake Pad Thickness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9.19
Stator, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.34
Specification, Cam Lobe Height . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.42
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
Specification, Cam Thrust Plate Fastener Torque . . . . . .3.46
Steering A-Arm Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.17
Specification, Camshaft Gear Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . .3.49
Steering Lock, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.4
Specification, Coolant Sensor Resistance . . . . . . . . . . .10.16
Steering Post Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
Specification, Cylinder Head Warp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.23
Steering Post Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
Specification, Cylinder Taper Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.31
Steering Torque Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2
Specification, Cylinder Warp Limit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.31
Storage Compartments, Front & Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30
Specification, Differential Solenoid Resistance 10.33, 10.34
Strut Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.21
Specification, Differential Solenoid Torque . . . 10.33, 10.34
Specification, Drill and Tap Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1.13 Strut Cartridge Replacement, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.20
Specification, Oil Pump Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.47 Suspension Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Specification, Oil Pump Rotor Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . .3.40 Suspension, Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Specification, PVT Center-to-Center Distance . . . . . . . .6.13 Suspension, Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.28
Specification, PVT Component Torque Table . . . . . . . . .6.2 T
Specification, PVT Drive Belt Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6.13 Temperature / Barometric Air Pressure Sensor (T-Bap) 4.15
Specification, Speed Sensor Bolt Torque . . . . . . . . . . .10.34 Throttle Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15
Specification, Standard Fastener Torques . . . . . . . . . . . .1.12 Throttle Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.15
Specification, Timing Gear Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.36 Throttle Position Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
Specification, Transmission Silent Chain Length . . . . . .8.35 Throttle Position Sensor Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.16
Specification, Valve Seat Contact Width . . . . . . . . . . . .3.27 Throttle Position Sensor Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.15
Specification, Valve Spring Free Length . . . . . . . . . . . .3.24 Tie Rod / Steering Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.24
Specification, Valve Stem Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.25 Timing Gear Mark Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.36
Specification, Valve Stem Guide I.D. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.25 Tire Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.30
Specification, Wheel Toe-Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2.25 Torque Specs - Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.10
Specifications, Body and Steering Torque Values . . . . . .5.2 Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.19
Specifications, Brake Component Service Limits . . . . . . .9.2 Transmission Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.12
Specifications, Brake Component Torque Values . . . . . .9.2 Transmission Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.7
Specifications, Cam Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.43 Transmission Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4
Specifications, Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.14 Transmission Gear Selector Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
Specifications, Crankcase Fastener Torque . . . . . . . . . . .3.44 Transmission Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.17
IX.4
Transmission Mounts, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.22
Transmission Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.6
Transmission Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.18 IX
Transmission, Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.27
Transmission, Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.20
Transmission, Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.25
Transmission, Output Shaft Backlash Procedure . . . . . . 8.33
Transmission, Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.32
Transmission, Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23
Transmission, Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.23
Troubleshooting, EFI Circuit Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.21
U
U-joint, Disassembly and Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7
V
Valve Seal/Spring Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.23
Valve Sealing Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.29
Valve Seat Reconditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.26
Vent Lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.16
Voltage Drop Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.38
W
Warn Winch Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.31
Wheel Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.25
Wheel Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
Wheel Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.29
Winch, Basic Wiring Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.45
Work Light Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.30
X
X2, Seat Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.30
IX.5
IX.6
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-1
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-3
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-4
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-5
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-6
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-7
WIRE DIAGRAM
WD-8